blob: ba4be660be9caf670948b378c51bd572ea377493 [file] [log] [blame]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001#
Wolfgang Denk1234ce72013-06-21 10:22:36 +02002# (C) Copyright 2000 - 2013
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003# Wolfgang Denk, DENX Software Engineering, wd@denx.de.
4#
Wolfgang Denk1234ce72013-06-21 10:22:36 +02005# SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0+
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006#
7
8Summary:
9========
10
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000011This directory contains the source code for U-Boot, a boot loader for
wdenkce4832c2004-10-17 21:12:06 +000012Embedded boards based on PowerPC, ARM, MIPS and several other
13processors, which can be installed in a boot ROM and used to
14initialize and test the hardware or to download and run application
15code.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000016
17The development of U-Boot is closely related to Linux: some parts of
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000018the source code originate in the Linux source tree, we have some
19header files in common, and special provision has been made to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000020support booting of Linux images.
21
22Some attention has been paid to make this software easily
23configurable and extendable. For instance, all monitor commands are
24implemented with the same call interface, so that it's very easy to
25add new commands. Also, instead of permanently adding rarely used
26code (for instance hardware test utilities) to the monitor, you can
27load and run it dynamically.
28
29
30Status:
31=======
32
33In general, all boards for which a configuration option exists in the
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000034Makefile have been tested to some extent and can be considered
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000035"working". In fact, many of them are used in production systems.
36
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000037In case of problems see the CHANGELOG and CREDITS files to find out
Albert ARIBAUD48e910f2013-09-11 15:52:51 +020038who contributed the specific port. The boards.cfg file lists board
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +010039maintainers.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000040
Robert P. J. Day974ed2f2012-11-14 02:03:20 +000041Note: There is no CHANGELOG file in the actual U-Boot source tree;
42it can be created dynamically from the Git log using:
43
44 make CHANGELOG
45
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000046
47Where to get help:
48==================
49
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000050In case you have questions about, problems with or contributions for
51U-Boot you should send a message to the U-Boot mailing list at
Peter Tyser8804a612008-09-10 09:18:34 -050052<u-boot@lists.denx.de>. There is also an archive of previous traffic
53on the mailing list - please search the archive before asking FAQ's.
54Please see http://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot and
55http://dir.gmane.org/gmane.comp.boot-loaders.u-boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000056
57
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +010058Where to get source code:
59=========================
60
61The U-Boot source code is maintained in the git repository at
62git://www.denx.de/git/u-boot.git ; you can browse it online at
63http://www.denx.de/cgi-bin/gitweb.cgi?p=u-boot.git;a=summary
64
65The "snapshot" links on this page allow you to download tarballs of
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +020066any version you might be interested in. Official releases are also
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +010067available for FTP download from the ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/
68directory.
69
Anatolij Gustschin08337f32008-03-26 18:13:33 +010070Pre-built (and tested) images are available from
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +010071ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/images/
72
73
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000074Where we come from:
75===================
76
77- start from 8xxrom sources
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000078- create PPCBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/ppcboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000079- clean up code
80- make it easier to add custom boards
81- make it possible to add other [PowerPC] CPUs
82- extend functions, especially:
83 * Provide extended interface to Linux boot loader
84 * S-Record download
85 * network boot
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +020086 * PCMCIA / CompactFlash / ATA disk / SCSI ... boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000087- create ARMBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/armboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000088- add other CPU families (starting with ARM)
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000089- create U-Boot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/u-boot)
Magnus Liljaf3b287b2008-08-06 19:32:33 +020090- current project page: see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000091
92
93Names and Spelling:
94===================
95
96The "official" name of this project is "Das U-Boot". The spelling
97"U-Boot" shall be used in all written text (documentation, comments
98in source files etc.). Example:
99
100 This is the README file for the U-Boot project.
101
102File names etc. shall be based on the string "u-boot". Examples:
103
104 include/asm-ppc/u-boot.h
105
106 #include <asm/u-boot.h>
107
108Variable names, preprocessor constants etc. shall be either based on
109the string "u_boot" or on "U_BOOT". Example:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000110
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +0000111 U_BOOT_VERSION u_boot_logo
112 IH_OS_U_BOOT u_boot_hush_start
113
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000114
wdenk7474aca2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000115Versioning:
116===========
117
Thomas Webere89e6282010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200118Starting with the release in October 2008, the names of the releases
119were changed from numerical release numbers without deeper meaning
120into a time stamp based numbering. Regular releases are identified by
121names consisting of the calendar year and month of the release date.
122Additional fields (if present) indicate release candidates or bug fix
123releases in "stable" maintenance trees.
wdenk7474aca2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000124
Thomas Webere89e6282010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200125Examples:
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +0000126 U-Boot v2009.11 - Release November 2009
Thomas Webere89e6282010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200127 U-Boot v2009.11.1 - Release 1 in version November 2009 stable tree
128 U-Boot v2010.09-rc1 - Release candiate 1 for September 2010 release
wdenk7474aca2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000129
130
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000131Directory Hierarchy:
132====================
133
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500134/arch Architecture specific files
135 /arm Files generic to ARM architecture
136 /cpu CPU specific files
137 /arm720t Files specific to ARM 720 CPUs
138 /arm920t Files specific to ARM 920 CPUs
Andreas Bießmannd9a9d562011-07-18 09:41:08 +0000139 /at91 Files specific to Atmel AT91RM9200 CPU
Wolfgang Denk16fa98a2010-06-13 17:48:15 +0200140 /imx Files specific to Freescale MC9328 i.MX CPUs
141 /s3c24x0 Files specific to Samsung S3C24X0 CPUs
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500142 /arm926ejs Files specific to ARM 926 CPUs
143 /arm1136 Files specific to ARM 1136 CPUs
144 /ixp Files specific to Intel XScale IXP CPUs
145 /pxa Files specific to Intel XScale PXA CPUs
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500146 /sa1100 Files specific to Intel StrongARM SA1100 CPUs
147 /lib Architecture specific library files
148 /avr32 Files generic to AVR32 architecture
149 /cpu CPU specific files
150 /lib Architecture specific library files
151 /blackfin Files generic to Analog Devices Blackfin architecture
152 /cpu CPU specific files
153 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500154 /m68k Files generic to m68k architecture
155 /cpu CPU specific files
156 /mcf52x2 Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF52x2 CPUs
157 /mcf5227x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5227x CPUs
158 /mcf532x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5329 CPUs
159 /mcf5445x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5445x CPUs
160 /mcf547x_8x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF547x_8x CPUs
161 /lib Architecture specific library files
162 /microblaze Files generic to microblaze architecture
163 /cpu CPU specific files
164 /lib Architecture specific library files
165 /mips Files generic to MIPS architecture
166 /cpu CPU specific files
Daniel Schwierzeckd52a6232011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200167 /mips32 Files specific to MIPS32 CPUs
Xiangfu Liu2f46d422011-10-12 12:24:06 +0800168 /xburst Files specific to Ingenic XBurst CPUs
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500169 /lib Architecture specific library files
Macpaul Lin1cac36e2011-10-19 20:41:11 +0000170 /nds32 Files generic to NDS32 architecture
171 /cpu CPU specific files
172 /n1213 Files specific to Andes Technology N1213 CPUs
173 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500174 /nios2 Files generic to Altera NIOS2 architecture
175 /cpu CPU specific files
176 /lib Architecture specific library files
Robert P. J. Daya269c932013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400177 /openrisc Files generic to OpenRISC architecture
178 /cpu CPU specific files
179 /lib Architecture specific library files
Stefan Roese88fbf932010-04-15 16:07:28 +0200180 /powerpc Files generic to PowerPC architecture
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500181 /cpu CPU specific files
182 /74xx_7xx Files specific to Freescale MPC74xx and 7xx CPUs
183 /mpc5xx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xx CPUs
184 /mpc5xxx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xxx CPUs
185 /mpc8xx Files specific to Freescale MPC8xx CPUs
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500186 /mpc824x Files specific to Freescale MPC824x CPUs
187 /mpc8260 Files specific to Freescale MPC8260 CPUs
188 /mpc85xx Files specific to Freescale MPC85xx CPUs
189 /ppc4xx Files specific to AMCC PowerPC 4xx CPUs
190 /lib Architecture specific library files
191 /sh Files generic to SH architecture
192 /cpu CPU specific files
193 /sh2 Files specific to sh2 CPUs
194 /sh3 Files specific to sh3 CPUs
195 /sh4 Files specific to sh4 CPUs
196 /lib Architecture specific library files
197 /sparc Files generic to SPARC architecture
198 /cpu CPU specific files
199 /leon2 Files specific to Gaisler LEON2 SPARC CPU
200 /leon3 Files specific to Gaisler LEON3 SPARC CPU
201 /lib Architecture specific library files
Robert P. J. Daya269c932013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400202 /x86 Files generic to x86 architecture
203 /cpu CPU specific files
204 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500205/api Machine/arch independent API for external apps
206/board Board dependent files
207/common Misc architecture independent functions
208/disk Code for disk drive partition handling
209/doc Documentation (don't expect too much)
210/drivers Commonly used device drivers
Robert P. J. Daya269c932013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400211/dts Contains Makefile for building internal U-Boot fdt.
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500212/examples Example code for standalone applications, etc.
213/fs Filesystem code (cramfs, ext2, jffs2, etc.)
214/include Header Files
215/lib Files generic to all architectures
216 /libfdt Library files to support flattened device trees
217 /lzma Library files to support LZMA decompression
218 /lzo Library files to support LZO decompression
219/net Networking code
220/post Power On Self Test
Robert P. J. Daya269c932013-09-15 18:34:15 -0400221/spl Secondary Program Loader framework
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500222/tools Tools to build S-Record or U-Boot images, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000223
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000224Software Configuration:
225=======================
226
227Configuration is usually done using C preprocessor defines; the
228rationale behind that is to avoid dead code whenever possible.
229
230There are two classes of configuration variables:
231
232* Configuration _OPTIONS_:
233 These are selectable by the user and have names beginning with
234 "CONFIG_".
235
236* Configuration _SETTINGS_:
237 These depend on the hardware etc. and should not be meddled with if
238 you don't know what you're doing; they have names beginning with
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200239 "CONFIG_SYS_".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000240
241Later we will add a configuration tool - probably similar to or even
242identical to what's used for the Linux kernel. Right now, we have to
243do the configuration by hand, which means creating some symbolic
244links and editing some configuration files. We use the TQM8xxL boards
245as an example here.
246
247
248Selection of Processor Architecture and Board Type:
249---------------------------------------------------
250
251For all supported boards there are ready-to-use default
252configurations available; just type "make <board_name>_config".
253
254Example: For a TQM823L module type:
255
256 cd u-boot
257 make TQM823L_config
258
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200259For the Cogent platform, you need to specify the CPU type as well;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000260e.g. "make cogent_mpc8xx_config". And also configure the cogent
261directory according to the instructions in cogent/README.
262
263
264Configuration Options:
265----------------------
266
267Configuration depends on the combination of board and CPU type; all
268such information is kept in a configuration file
269"include/configs/<board_name>.h".
270
271Example: For a TQM823L module, all configuration settings are in
272"include/configs/TQM823L.h".
273
274
wdenk1272e232002-11-10 22:06:23 +0000275Many of the options are named exactly as the corresponding Linux
276kernel configuration options. The intention is to make it easier to
277build a config tool - later.
278
279
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000280The following options need to be configured:
281
Kim Phillips203fee32007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500282- CPU Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC85XX.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000283
Kim Phillips203fee32007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500284- Board Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC8540ADS.
Wolfgang Denk994ad962006-10-24 14:42:37 +0200285
286- CPU Daughterboard Type: (if CONFIG_ATSTK1000 is defined)
Haavard Skinnemoen9d5a43f2007-11-01 12:44:20 +0100287 Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_ATSTK1002
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000288
289- CPU Module Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
290 Define exactly one of
291 CONFIG_CMA286_60_OLD
292--- FIXME --- not tested yet:
293 CONFIG_CMA286_60, CONFIG_CMA286_21, CONFIG_CMA286_60P,
294 CONFIG_CMA287_23, CONFIG_CMA287_50
295
296- Motherboard Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
297 Define exactly one of
298 CONFIG_CMA101, CONFIG_CMA102
299
300- Motherboard I/O Modules: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
301 Define one or more of
302 CONFIG_CMA302
303
304- Motherboard Options: (if CONFIG_CMA101 or CONFIG_CMA102 are defined)
305 Define one or more of
306 CONFIG_LCD_HEARTBEAT - update a character position on
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200307 the LCD display every second with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000308 a "rotator" |\-/|\-/
309
wdenk2bb11052003-07-17 23:16:40 +0000310- Board flavour: (if CONFIG_MPC8260ADS is defined)
311 CONFIG_ADSTYPE
312 Possible values are:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200313 CONFIG_SYS_8260ADS - original MPC8260ADS
314 CONFIG_SYS_8266ADS - MPC8266ADS
315 CONFIG_SYS_PQ2FADS - PQ2FADS-ZU or PQ2FADS-VR
316 CONFIG_SYS_8272ADS - MPC8272ADS
wdenk2bb11052003-07-17 23:16:40 +0000317
Lei Wen20014762011-02-09 18:06:58 +0530318- Marvell Family Member
319 CONFIG_SYS_MVFS - define it if you want to enable
320 multiple fs option at one time
321 for marvell soc family
322
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000323- MPC824X Family Member (if CONFIG_MPC824X is defined)
wdenk9b7f3842003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000324 Define exactly one of
325 CONFIG_MPC8240, CONFIG_MPC8245
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000326
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200327- 8xx CPU Options: (if using an MPC8xx CPU)
wdenk20bddb32004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000328 CONFIG_8xx_GCLK_FREQ - deprecated: CPU clock if
329 get_gclk_freq() cannot work
wdenk9b7f3842003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000330 e.g. if there is no 32KHz
331 reference PIT/RTC clock
wdenk20bddb32004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000332 CONFIG_8xx_OSCLK - PLL input clock (either EXTCLK
333 or XTAL/EXTAL)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000334
wdenk20bddb32004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000335- 859/866/885 CPU options: (if using a MPC859 or MPC866 or MPC885 CPU):
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200336 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MIN
337 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MAX
wdenk20bddb32004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000338 CONFIG_8xx_CPUCLK_DEFAULT
wdenkfde37042004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000339 See doc/README.MPC866
340
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200341 CONFIG_SYS_MEASURE_CPUCLK
wdenkfde37042004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000342
wdenk544e9732004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000343 Define this to measure the actual CPU clock instead
344 of relying on the correctness of the configured
345 values. Mostly useful for board bringup to make sure
346 the PLL is locked at the intended frequency. Note
347 that this requires a (stable) reference clock (32 kHz
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200348 RTC clock or CONFIG_SYS_8XX_XIN)
wdenkfde37042004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000349
Heiko Schocher734f0272009-03-12 07:37:15 +0100350 CONFIG_SYS_DELAYED_ICACHE
351
352 Define this option if you want to enable the
353 ICache only when Code runs from RAM.
354
Kumar Galaf4fb90f2011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600355- 85xx CPU Options:
York Sun2394a0f2012-10-08 07:44:30 +0000356 CONFIG_SYS_PPC64
357
358 Specifies that the core is a 64-bit PowerPC implementation (implements
359 the "64" category of the Power ISA). This is necessary for ePAPR
360 compliance, among other possible reasons.
361
Kumar Galaf4fb90f2011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600362 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_TBCLK_DIV
363
364 Defines the core time base clock divider ratio compared to the
365 system clock. On most PQ3 devices this is 8, on newer QorIQ
366 devices it can be 16 or 32. The ratio varies from SoC to Soc.
367
Kumar Gala179b1b22011-05-20 00:39:21 -0500368 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PCIE_COMPAT
369
370 Defines the string to utilize when trying to match PCIe device
371 tree nodes for the given platform.
372
Prabhakar Kushwahaa6a30622012-04-29 23:56:13 +0000373 CONFIG_SYS_PPC_E500_DEBUG_TLB
374
375 Enables a temporary TLB entry to be used during boot to work
376 around limitations in e500v1 and e500v2 external debugger
377 support. This reduces the portions of the boot code where
378 breakpoints and single stepping do not work. The value of this
379 symbol should be set to the TLB1 entry to be used for this
380 purpose.
381
Scott Wood80806962012-08-14 10:14:53 +0000382 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510
383
384 Enables a workaround for erratum A004510. If set,
385 then CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV and
386 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY must be set.
387
388 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV
389 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV2 (optional)
390
391 Defines one or two SoC revisions (low 8 bits of SVR)
392 for which the A004510 workaround should be applied.
393
394 The rest of SVR is either not relevant to the decision
395 of whether the erratum is present (e.g. p2040 versus
396 p2041) or is implied by the build target, which controls
397 whether CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510 is set.
398
399 See Freescale App Note 4493 for more information about
400 this erratum.
401
Prabhakar Kushwahad324f472013-04-16 13:27:44 +0530402 CONFIG_A003399_NOR_WORKAROUND
403 Enables a workaround for IFC erratum A003399. It is only
404 requred during NOR boot.
405
Scott Wood80806962012-08-14 10:14:53 +0000406 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY
407
408 This is the value to write into CCSR offset 0x18600
409 according to the A004510 workaround.
410
Priyanka Jainc73b9032013-07-02 09:21:04 +0530411 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_DDR_ADDR
412 This value denotes start offset of DDR memory which is
413 connected exclusively to the DSP cores.
414
Priyanka Jainf81e8b22013-04-04 09:31:54 +0530415 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_M2_RAM_ADDR
416 This value denotes start offset of M2 memory
417 which is directly connected to the DSP core.
418
Priyanka Jainc73b9032013-07-02 09:21:04 +0530419 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_M3_RAM_ADDR
420 This value denotes start offset of M3 memory which is directly
421 connected to the DSP core.
422
Priyanka Jainf81e8b22013-04-04 09:31:54 +0530423 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DSP_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT
424 This value denotes start offset of DSP CCSR space.
425
Priyanka Jaine9dcaa82013-12-17 14:25:52 +0530426 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_SINGLE_SOURCE_CLK
427 Single Source Clock is clocking mode present in some of FSL SoC's.
428 In this mode, a single differential clock is used to supply
429 clocks to the sysclock, ddrclock and usbclock.
430
Daniel Schwierzeckd8a49ca2012-04-02 02:57:56 +0000431- Generic CPU options:
432 CONFIG_SYS_BIG_ENDIAN, CONFIG_SYS_LITTLE_ENDIAN
433
434 Defines the endianess of the CPU. Implementation of those
435 values is arch specific.
436
York Sunf0626592013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700437 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR
438 Freescale DDR driver in use. This type of DDR controller is
439 found in mpc83xx, mpc85xx, mpc86xx as well as some ARM core
440 SoCs.
441
442 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_ADDR
443 Freescale DDR memory-mapped register base.
444
445 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR_EMU
446 Specify emulator support for DDR. Some DDR features such as
447 deskew training are not available.
448
449 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN1
450 Freescale DDR1 controller.
451
452 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN2
453 Freescale DDR2 controller.
454
455 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_GEN3
456 Freescale DDR3 controller.
457
York Sun461c9392013-09-30 14:20:51 -0700458 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDRC_ARM_GEN3
459 Freescale DDR3 controller for ARM-based SoCs.
460
York Sunf0626592013-09-30 09:22:09 -0700461 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR1
462 Board config to use DDR1. It can be enabled for SoCs with
463 Freescale DDR1 or DDR2 controllers, depending on the board
464 implemetation.
465
466 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR2
467 Board config to use DDR2. It can be eanbeld for SoCs with
468 Freescale DDR2 or DDR3 controllers, depending on the board
469 implementation.
470
471 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_DDR3
472 Board config to use DDR3. It can be enabled for SoCs with
473 Freescale DDR3 controllers.
474
Prabhakar Kushwaha950f2f72014-01-13 11:28:04 +0530475 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PBL_PBI
476 It enables addition of RCW (Power on reset configuration) in built image.
477 Please refer doc/README.pblimage for more details
478
479 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PBL_RCW
480 It adds PBI(pre-boot instructions) commands in u-boot build image.
481 PBI commands can be used to configure SoC before it starts the execution.
482 Please refer doc/README.pblimage for more details
483
Markus Klotzbuecher6e5c19a2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100484- Intel Monahans options:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200485 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_RUN_MODE_OSC_RATIO
Markus Klotzbuecher6e5c19a2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100486
487 Defines the Monahans run mode to oscillator
488 ratio. Valid values are 8, 16, 24, 31. The core
489 frequency is this value multiplied by 13 MHz.
490
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200491 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_TURBO_RUN_MODE_RATIO
Wolfgang Denkebd3deb2006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200492
Markus Klotzbuecher6e5c19a2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100493 Defines the Monahans turbo mode to oscillator
494 ratio. Valid values are 1 (default if undefined) and
Wolfgang Denkebd3deb2006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200495 2. The core frequency as calculated above is multiplied
Markus Klotzbuecher6e5c19a2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100496 by this value.
Wolfgang Denkebd3deb2006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200497
Daniel Schwierzeckd52a6232011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200498- MIPS CPU options:
499 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_SP_OFFSET
500
501 Offset relative to CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE for initial stack
502 pointer. This is needed for the temporary stack before
503 relocation.
504
505 CONFIG_SYS_MIPS_CACHE_MODE
506
507 Cache operation mode for the MIPS CPU.
508 See also arch/mips/include/asm/mipsregs.h.
509 Possible values are:
510 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NO_WA
511 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_WA
512 CONF_CM_UNCACHED
513 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NONCOHERENT
514 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CE
515 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_COW
516 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CUW
517 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_ACCELERATED
518
519 CONFIG_SYS_XWAY_EBU_BOOTCFG
520
521 Special option for Lantiq XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash.
522 See also arch/mips/cpu/mips32/start.S.
523
524 CONFIG_XWAY_SWAP_BYTES
525
526 Enable compilation of tools/xway-swap-bytes needed for Lantiq
527 XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash. The U-Boot image needs to
528 be swapped if a flash programmer is used.
529
Christian Riesch48c2d6d2012-02-02 00:44:39 +0000530- ARM options:
531 CONFIG_SYS_EXCEPTION_VECTORS_HIGH
532
533 Select high exception vectors of the ARM core, e.g., do not
534 clear the V bit of the c1 register of CP15.
535
Aneesh Vb8e40802012-03-08 07:20:19 +0000536 CONFIG_SYS_THUMB_BUILD
537
538 Use this flag to build U-Boot using the Thumb instruction
539 set for ARM architectures. Thumb instruction set provides
540 better code density. For ARM architectures that support
541 Thumb2 this flag will result in Thumb2 code generated by
542 GCC.
543
Stephen Warrenc63c3502013-03-04 13:29:40 +0000544 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_716044
Stephen Warrene9d59c92013-02-26 12:28:27 +0000545 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_742230
546 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_743622
547 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_751472
548
549 If set, the workarounds for these ARM errata are applied early
550 during U-Boot startup. Note that these options force the
551 workarounds to be applied; no CPU-type/version detection
552 exists, unlike the similar options in the Linux kernel. Do not
553 set these options unless they apply!
554
Stephen Warren445d56c2013-03-27 17:06:41 +0000555- CPU timer options:
556 CONFIG_SYS_HZ
557
558 The frequency of the timer returned by get_timer().
559 get_timer() must operate in milliseconds and this CONFIG
560 option must be set to 1000.
561
wdenk9b7f3842003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000562- Linux Kernel Interface:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000563 CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ
564
565 U-Boot stores all clock information in Hz
566 internally. For binary compatibility with older Linux
567 kernels (which expect the clocks passed in the
568 bd_info data to be in MHz) the environment variable
569 "clocks_in_mhz" can be defined so that U-Boot
570 converts clock data to MHZ before passing it to the
571 Linux kernel.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000572 When CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ is defined, a definition of
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +0100573 "clocks_in_mhz=1" is automatically included in the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000574 default environment.
575
wdenk9b7f3842003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000576 CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES [relevant for MIPS only]
577
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200578 When transferring memsize parameter to linux, some versions
wdenk9b7f3842003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000579 expect it to be in bytes, others in MB.
580 Define CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES to make it in bytes.
581
Gerald Van Barenfcd91bb2008-06-03 20:34:45 -0400582 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
Wolfgang Denk27a5b0b2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200583
584 New kernel versions are expecting firmware settings to be
Gerald Van Barend6abef42007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400585 passed using flattened device trees (based on open firmware
586 concepts).
587
588 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
589 * New libfdt-based support
590 * Adds the "fdt" command
Kim Phillips9b46eb62007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500591 * The bootm command automatically updates the fdt
Gerald Van Barend6abef42007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400592
Marcel Ziswilerb29bc712009-09-09 21:18:41 +0200593 OF_CPU - The proper name of the cpus node (only required for
594 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
595 OF_SOC - The proper name of the soc node (only required for
596 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
Wolfgang Denk27a5b0b2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200597 OF_TBCLK - The timebase frequency.
Kumar Galae40c2b52006-01-11 13:59:02 -0600598 OF_STDOUT_PATH - The path to the console device
Wolfgang Denk27a5b0b2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200599
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200600 boards with QUICC Engines require OF_QE to set UCC MAC
601 addresses
Kim Phillips9b46eb62007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500602
Kumar Gala1e26aa52006-01-11 13:54:17 -0600603 CONFIG_OF_BOARD_SETUP
604
605 Board code has addition modification that it wants to make
606 to the flat device tree before handing it off to the kernel
wdenkda04a8b2004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000607
Matthew McClintockefae4ca2006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500608 CONFIG_OF_BOOT_CPU
609
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200610 This define fills in the correct boot CPU in the boot
Matthew McClintockefae4ca2006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500611 param header, the default value is zero if undefined.
612
Heiko Schocherffb293a2009-09-23 07:56:08 +0200613 CONFIG_OF_IDE_FIXUP
614
615 U-Boot can detect if an IDE device is present or not.
616 If not, and this new config option is activated, U-Boot
617 removes the ATA node from the DTS before booting Linux,
618 so the Linux IDE driver does not probe the device and
619 crash. This is needed for buggy hardware (uc101) where
620 no pull down resistor is connected to the signal IDE5V_DD7.
621
Igor Grinberg06890672011-07-14 05:45:07 +0000622 CONFIG_MACH_TYPE [relevant for ARM only][mandatory]
623
624 This setting is mandatory for all boards that have only one
625 machine type and must be used to specify the machine type
626 number as it appears in the ARM machine registry
627 (see http://www.arm.linux.org.uk/developer/machines/).
628 Only boards that have multiple machine types supported
629 in a single configuration file and the machine type is
630 runtime discoverable, do not have to use this setting.
631
Niklaus Giger0ab978d2008-11-03 22:13:47 +0100632- vxWorks boot parameters:
633
634 bootvx constructs a valid bootline using the following
635 environments variables: bootfile, ipaddr, serverip, hostname.
636 It loads the vxWorks image pointed bootfile.
637
638 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_DEVICE - The vxworks device name
639 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_MAC_PTR - Ethernet 6 byte MA -address
640 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_SERVERNAME - Name of the server
641 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_ADDR - Address of boot parameters
642
643 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_ADD_PARAMS
644
645 Add it at the end of the bootline. E.g "u=username pw=secret"
646
647 Note: If a "bootargs" environment is defined, it will overwride
648 the defaults discussed just above.
649
Aneesh V960f5c02011-06-16 23:30:47 +0000650- Cache Configuration:
651 CONFIG_SYS_ICACHE_OFF - Do not enable instruction cache in U-Boot
652 CONFIG_SYS_DCACHE_OFF - Do not enable data cache in U-Boot
653 CONFIG_SYS_L2CACHE_OFF- Do not enable L2 cache in U-Boot
654
Aneesh V686a0752011-06-16 23:30:51 +0000655- Cache Configuration for ARM:
656 CONFIG_SYS_L2_PL310 - Enable support for ARM PL310 L2 cache
657 controller
658 CONFIG_SYS_PL310_BASE - Physical base address of PL310
659 controller register space
660
wdenkda04a8b2004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000661- Serial Ports:
Andreas Engel0813b122008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200662 CONFIG_PL010_SERIAL
wdenkda04a8b2004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000663
664 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL010 UARTs.
665
Andreas Engel0813b122008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200666 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL
wdenkda04a8b2004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000667
668 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs.
669
670 CONFIG_PL011_CLOCK
671
672 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs, set this variable to
673 the clock speed of the UARTs.
674
675 CONFIG_PL01x_PORTS
676
677 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL010 or PL011 UARTs on your board,
678 define this to a list of base addresses for each (supported)
679 port. See e.g. include/configs/versatile.h
680
John Rigby34e21ee2011-04-19 10:42:39 +0000681 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_RLCR
682
683 Some vendor versions of PL011 serial ports (e.g. ST-Ericsson U8500)
684 have separate receive and transmit line control registers. Set
685 this variable to initialize the extra register.
686
687 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_FLUSH_ON_INIT
688
689 On some platforms (e.g. U8500) U-Boot is loaded by a second stage
690 boot loader that has already initialized the UART. Define this
691 variable to flush the UART at init time.
692
wdenkda04a8b2004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000693
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000694- Console Interface:
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000695 Depending on board, define exactly one serial port
696 (like CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC1, CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC2,
697 CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SCC1, ...), or switch off the serial
698 console by defining CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000699
700 Note: if CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE is defined, the serial
701 port routines must be defined elsewhere
702 (i.e. serial_init(), serial_getc(), ...)
703
704 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
705 Enables console device for a color framebuffer. Needs following
Wolfgang Denkf6e50a42011-12-07 12:19:20 +0000706 defines (cf. smiLynxEM, i8042)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000707 VIDEO_FB_LITTLE_ENDIAN graphic memory organisation
708 (default big endian)
709 VIDEO_HW_RECTFILL graphic chip supports
710 rectangle fill
711 (cf. smiLynxEM)
712 VIDEO_HW_BITBLT graphic chip supports
713 bit-blit (cf. smiLynxEM)
714 VIDEO_VISIBLE_COLS visible pixel columns
715 (cols=pitch)
wdenk544e9732004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000716 VIDEO_VISIBLE_ROWS visible pixel rows
717 VIDEO_PIXEL_SIZE bytes per pixel
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000718 VIDEO_DATA_FORMAT graphic data format
719 (0-5, cf. cfb_console.c)
wdenk544e9732004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000720 VIDEO_FB_ADRS framebuffer address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000721 VIDEO_KBD_INIT_FCT keyboard int fct
722 (i.e. i8042_kbd_init())
723 VIDEO_TSTC_FCT test char fct
724 (i.e. i8042_tstc)
725 VIDEO_GETC_FCT get char fct
726 (i.e. i8042_getc)
727 CONFIG_CONSOLE_CURSOR cursor drawing on/off
728 (requires blink timer
729 cf. i8042.c)
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200730 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_BLINK_COUNT blink interval (cf. i8042.c)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000731 CONFIG_CONSOLE_TIME display time/date info in
732 upper right corner
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500733 (requires CONFIG_CMD_DATE)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000734 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO display Linux logo in
735 upper left corner
wdenk9dd2b882002-12-03 21:28:10 +0000736 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO use bmp_logo.h instead of
737 linux_logo.h for logo.
738 Requires CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000739 CONFIG_CONSOLE_EXTRA_INFO
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200740 additional board info beside
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000741 the logo
742
Pali Rohár4a57da32012-10-19 13:30:09 +0000743 When CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE_ANSI is defined, console will support
744 a limited number of ANSI escape sequences (cursor control,
745 erase functions and limited graphics rendition control).
746
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000747 When CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE is defined, video console is
748 default i/o. Serial console can be forced with
749 environment 'console=serial'.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000750
wdenk1ebf41e2004-01-02 14:00:00 +0000751 When CONFIG_SILENT_CONSOLE is defined, all console
752 messages (by U-Boot and Linux!) can be silenced with
753 the "silent" environment variable. See
754 doc/README.silent for more information.
wdenk3da587e2003-10-19 23:22:11 +0000755
Heiko Schocher62759562013-10-22 11:06:06 +0200756 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_BG_COL: define the backgroundcolor, default
757 is 0x00.
758 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_FG_COL: define the foregroundcolor, default
759 is 0xa0.
760
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000761- Console Baudrate:
762 CONFIG_BAUDRATE - in bps
763 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200764 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
765 CONFIG_SYS_BRGCLK_PRESCALE, baudrate prescale
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000766
Heiko Schocher327480a2009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100767- Console Rx buffer length
768 With CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN it is possible to define
769 the maximum receive buffer length for the SMC.
Heiko Schocher362447f2009-02-10 09:31:47 +0100770 This option is actual only for 82xx and 8xx possible.
Heiko Schocher327480a2009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100771 If using CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN also CONFIG_SYS_MAXIDLE
772 must be defined, to setup the maximum idle timeout for
773 the SMC.
774
Graeme Russ3c28f482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000775- Pre-Console Buffer:
Wolfgang Denkd590fb12011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200776 Prior to the console being initialised (i.e. serial UART
777 initialised etc) all console output is silently discarded.
778 Defining CONFIG_PRE_CONSOLE_BUFFER will cause U-Boot to
779 buffer any console messages prior to the console being
780 initialised to a buffer of size CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
781 bytes located at CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_ADDR. The buffer is
782 a circular buffer, so if more than CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
Wolfgang Denk23f78482011-10-09 21:06:34 +0200783 bytes are output before the console is initialised, the
Wolfgang Denkd590fb12011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200784 earlier bytes are discarded.
Graeme Russ3c28f482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000785
Wolfgang Denkd590fb12011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200786 'Sane' compilers will generate smaller code if
787 CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ is a power of 2
Graeme Russ3c28f482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000788
Sonny Raocd55bde2011-11-02 09:52:08 +0000789- Safe printf() functions
790 Define CONFIG_SYS_VSNPRINTF to compile in safe versions of
791 the printf() functions. These are defined in
792 include/vsprintf.h and include snprintf(), vsnprintf() and
793 so on. Code size increase is approximately 300-500 bytes.
794 If this option is not given then these functions will
795 silently discard their buffer size argument - this means
796 you are not getting any overflow checking in this case.
797
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000798- Boot Delay: CONFIG_BOOTDELAY - in seconds
799 Delay before automatically booting the default image;
800 set to -1 to disable autoboot.
Joe Hershberger96ccaf32012-08-17 10:53:12 +0000801 set to -2 to autoboot with no delay and not check for abort
802 (even when CONFIG_ZERO_BOOTDELAY_CHECK is defined).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000803
804 See doc/README.autoboot for these options that
805 work with CONFIG_BOOTDELAY. None are required.
806 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
807 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_MIN
808 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_KEYED
809 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_PROMPT
810 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
811 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
812 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR2
813 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR2
814 CONFIG_ZERO_BOOTDELAY_CHECK
815 CONFIG_RESET_TO_RETRY
816
817- Autoboot Command:
818 CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
819 Only needed when CONFIG_BOOTDELAY is enabled;
820 define a command string that is automatically executed
821 when no character is read on the console interface
822 within "Boot Delay" after reset.
823
824 CONFIG_BOOTARGS
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000825 This can be used to pass arguments to the bootm
826 command. The value of CONFIG_BOOTARGS goes into the
827 environment value "bootargs".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000828
829 CONFIG_RAMBOOT and CONFIG_NFSBOOT
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000830 The value of these goes into the environment as
831 "ramboot" and "nfsboot" respectively, and can be used
832 as a convenience, when switching between booting from
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200833 RAM and NFS.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000834
Heiko Schocher040c5c32013-11-04 14:04:59 +0100835- Bootcount:
836 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_LIMIT
837 Implements a mechanism for detecting a repeating reboot
838 cycle, see:
839 http://www.denx.de/wiki/view/DULG/UBootBootCountLimit
840
841 CONFIG_BOOTCOUNT_ENV
842 If no softreset save registers are found on the hardware
843 "bootcount" is stored in the environment. To prevent a
844 saveenv on all reboots, the environment variable
845 "upgrade_available" is used. If "upgrade_available" is
846 0, "bootcount" is always 0, if "upgrade_available" is
847 1 "bootcount" is incremented in the environment.
848 So the Userspace Applikation must set the "upgrade_available"
849 and "bootcount" variable to 0, if a boot was successfully.
850
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000851- Pre-Boot Commands:
852 CONFIG_PREBOOT
853
854 When this option is #defined, the existence of the
855 environment variable "preboot" will be checked
856 immediately before starting the CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
857 countdown and/or running the auto-boot command resp.
858 entering interactive mode.
859
860 This feature is especially useful when "preboot" is
861 automatically generated or modified. For an example
862 see the LWMON board specific code: here "preboot" is
863 modified when the user holds down a certain
864 combination of keys on the (special) keyboard when
865 booting the systems
866
867- Serial Download Echo Mode:
868 CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
869 If defined to 1, all characters received during a
870 serial download (using the "loads" command) are
871 echoed back. This might be needed by some terminal
872 emulations (like "cu"), but may as well just take
873 time on others. This setting #define's the initial
874 value of the "loads_echo" environment variable.
875
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500876- Kgdb Serial Baudrate: (if CONFIG_CMD_KGDB is defined)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000877 CONFIG_KGDB_BAUDRATE
878 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200879 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000880
881- Monitor Functions:
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500882 Monitor commands can be included or excluded
883 from the build by using the #include files
Stephen Warren963a7cf2012-08-05 16:07:19 +0000884 <config_cmd_all.h> and #undef'ing unwanted
885 commands, or using <config_cmd_default.h>
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500886 and augmenting with additional #define's
887 for wanted commands.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000888
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500889 The default command configuration includes all commands
890 except those marked below with a "*".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000891
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500892 CONFIG_CMD_ASKENV * ask for env variable
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500893 CONFIG_CMD_BDI bdinfo
894 CONFIG_CMD_BEDBUG * Include BedBug Debugger
895 CONFIG_CMD_BMP * BMP support
896 CONFIG_CMD_BSP * Board specific commands
897 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTD bootd
898 CONFIG_CMD_CACHE * icache, dcache
Michal Simeka0d28022013-11-21 13:39:02 -0800899 CONFIG_CMD_CLK * clock command support
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500900 CONFIG_CMD_CONSOLE coninfo
Mike Frysinger321ab9e2010-12-21 14:19:51 -0500901 CONFIG_CMD_CRC32 * crc32
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500902 CONFIG_CMD_DATE * support for RTC, date/time...
903 CONFIG_CMD_DHCP * DHCP support
904 CONFIG_CMD_DIAG * Diagnostics
Peter Tyser15258042008-12-17 16:36:22 -0600905 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510 * ds4510 I2C gpio commands
906 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_INFO * ds4510 I2C info command
907 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_MEM * ds4510 I2C eeprom/sram commansd
908 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_RST * ds4510 I2C rst command
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500909 CONFIG_CMD_DTT * Digital Therm and Thermostat
910 CONFIG_CMD_ECHO echo arguments
Peter Tyser0deafa22009-10-25 15:12:56 -0500911 CONFIG_CMD_EDITENV edit env variable
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500912 CONFIG_CMD_EEPROM * EEPROM read/write support
913 CONFIG_CMD_ELF * bootelf, bootvx
Joe Hershberger1b0d5512012-12-11 22:16:25 -0600914 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_CALLBACK * display details about env callbacks
Joe Hershbergera2d62b72012-12-11 22:16:33 -0600915 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_FLAGS * display details about env flags
Andrew Ruder94463402013-10-22 19:07:34 -0500916 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_EXISTS * check existence of env variable
Mike Frysingerf3ddf202010-12-26 23:09:45 -0500917 CONFIG_CMD_EXPORTENV * export the environment
Stephen Warren4f8662d2012-10-22 06:43:50 +0000918 CONFIG_CMD_EXT2 * ext2 command support
919 CONFIG_CMD_EXT4 * ext4 command support
Mike Frysinger78dcaf42009-01-28 19:08:14 -0500920 CONFIG_CMD_SAVEENV saveenv
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500921 CONFIG_CMD_FDC * Floppy Disk Support
Stephen Warren4f8662d2012-10-22 06:43:50 +0000922 CONFIG_CMD_FAT * FAT command support
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500923 CONFIG_CMD_FDOS * Dos diskette Support
924 CONFIG_CMD_FLASH flinfo, erase, protect
925 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA FPGA device initialization support
Vincent Stehléa618f2b2013-06-20 18:14:22 +0200926 CONFIG_CMD_FUSE * Device fuse support
Anton Staafd1390c82012-12-05 14:46:29 +0000927 CONFIG_CMD_GETTIME * Get time since boot
Mike Frysinger2ed02412010-12-26 23:32:22 -0500928 CONFIG_CMD_GO * the 'go' command (exec code)
Kim Phillipsf0c9d532011-04-05 07:15:14 +0000929 CONFIG_CMD_GREPENV * search environment
Simon Glass058bb8d2012-12-05 14:46:38 +0000930 CONFIG_CMD_HASH * calculate hash / digest
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500931 CONFIG_CMD_HWFLOW * RTS/CTS hw flow control
932 CONFIG_CMD_I2C * I2C serial bus support
933 CONFIG_CMD_IDE * IDE harddisk support
934 CONFIG_CMD_IMI iminfo
Vipin Kumar3df41b12012-12-16 22:32:48 +0000935 CONFIG_CMD_IMLS List all images found in NOR flash
Vincent Stehléa618f2b2013-06-20 18:14:22 +0200936 CONFIG_CMD_IMLS_NAND * List all images found in NAND flash
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500937 CONFIG_CMD_IMMAP * IMMR dump support
Mike Frysingerf3ddf202010-12-26 23:09:45 -0500938 CONFIG_CMD_IMPORTENV * import an environment
Joe Hershberger0fd32d72012-10-03 11:15:51 +0000939 CONFIG_CMD_INI * import data from an ini file into the env
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500940 CONFIG_CMD_IRQ * irqinfo
941 CONFIG_CMD_ITEST Integer/string test of 2 values
942 CONFIG_CMD_JFFS2 * JFFS2 Support
943 CONFIG_CMD_KGDB * kgdb
Vincent Stehléa618f2b2013-06-20 18:14:22 +0200944 CONFIG_CMD_LDRINFO * ldrinfo (display Blackfin loader)
Joe Hershbergerb35a3a62012-05-23 08:00:12 +0000945 CONFIG_CMD_LINK_LOCAL * link-local IP address auto-configuration
946 (169.254.*.*)
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500947 CONFIG_CMD_LOADB loadb
948 CONFIG_CMD_LOADS loads
Vincent Stehléa618f2b2013-06-20 18:14:22 +0200949 CONFIG_CMD_MD5SUM * print md5 message digest
Robin Getz93d6cb02009-07-27 00:07:59 -0400950 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY and CONFIG_MD5)
Simon Glasseacd14f2012-11-30 13:01:20 +0000951 CONFIG_CMD_MEMINFO * Display detailed memory information
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500952 CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY md, mm, nm, mw, cp, cmp, crc, base,
Wolfgang Denk9d009282013-03-08 10:51:32 +0000953 loop, loopw
Vincent Stehléa618f2b2013-06-20 18:14:22 +0200954 CONFIG_CMD_MEMTEST * mtest
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500955 CONFIG_CMD_MISC Misc functions like sleep etc
956 CONFIG_CMD_MMC * MMC memory mapped support
957 CONFIG_CMD_MII * MII utility commands
Stefan Roeseb1423dd2009-03-19 13:30:36 +0100958 CONFIG_CMD_MTDPARTS * MTD partition support
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500959 CONFIG_CMD_NAND * NAND support
960 CONFIG_CMD_NET bootp, tftpboot, rarpboot
Vincent Stehléa618f2b2013-06-20 18:14:22 +0200961 CONFIG_CMD_NFS NFS support
Peter Tyser9902e422008-12-17 16:36:21 -0600962 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X * PCA953x I2C gpio commands
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +0000963 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X_INFO * PCA953x I2C gpio info command
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500964 CONFIG_CMD_PCI * pciinfo
965 CONFIG_CMD_PCMCIA * PCMCIA support
966 CONFIG_CMD_PING * send ICMP ECHO_REQUEST to network
967 host
968 CONFIG_CMD_PORTIO * Port I/O
Kenneth Watersc889fb42012-12-05 14:46:30 +0000969 CONFIG_CMD_READ * Read raw data from partition
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500970 CONFIG_CMD_REGINFO * Register dump
971 CONFIG_CMD_RUN run command in env variable
Simon Glassbf6ce792012-12-26 09:53:36 +0000972 CONFIG_CMD_SANDBOX * sb command to access sandbox features
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500973 CONFIG_CMD_SAVES * save S record dump
974 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI * SCSI Support
975 CONFIG_CMD_SDRAM * print SDRAM configuration information
976 (requires CONFIG_CMD_I2C)
977 CONFIG_CMD_SETGETDCR Support for DCR Register access
978 (4xx only)
Eric Nelson97f5f8f2012-01-31 10:52:08 -0700979 CONFIG_CMD_SF * Read/write/erase SPI NOR flash
Vincent Stehléa618f2b2013-06-20 18:14:22 +0200980 CONFIG_CMD_SHA1SUM * print sha1 memory digest
Robin Getz93d6cb02009-07-27 00:07:59 -0400981 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY)
Bob Liua671b702013-02-05 19:05:41 +0800982 CONFIG_CMD_SOFTSWITCH * Soft switch setting command for BF60x
Wolfgang Denk85c25df2009-04-01 23:34:12 +0200983 CONFIG_CMD_SOURCE "source" command Support
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500984 CONFIG_CMD_SPI * SPI serial bus support
Luca Ceresoli7aa81a42011-05-17 00:03:40 +0000985 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPSRV * TFTP transfer in server mode
Simon Glass6a398d22011-10-24 18:00:07 +0000986 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPPUT * TFTP put command (upload)
Joe Hershberger59f3f522012-10-03 12:14:57 +0000987 CONFIG_CMD_TIME * run command and report execution time (ARM specific)
988 CONFIG_CMD_TIMER * access to the system tick timer
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500989 CONFIG_CMD_USB * USB support
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500990 CONFIG_CMD_CDP * Cisco Discover Protocol support
Marek Vasut71729392012-03-31 07:47:16 +0000991 CONFIG_CMD_MFSL * Microblaze FSL support
Vincent Stehléa618f2b2013-06-20 18:14:22 +0200992 CONFIG_CMD_XIMG Load part of Multi Image
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000993
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000994
995 EXAMPLE: If you want all functions except of network
996 support you can write:
997
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500998 #include "config_cmd_all.h"
999 #undef CONFIG_CMD_NET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001000
Gerald Van Barend6abef42007-03-31 12:23:51 -04001001 Other Commands:
1002 fdt (flattened device tree) command: CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001003
1004 Note: Don't enable the "icache" and "dcache" commands
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001005 (configuration option CONFIG_CMD_CACHE) unless you know
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001006 what you (and your U-Boot users) are doing. Data
1007 cache cannot be enabled on systems like the 8xx or
1008 8260 (where accesses to the IMMR region must be
1009 uncached), and it cannot be disabled on all other
1010 systems where we (mis-) use the data cache to hold an
1011 initial stack and some data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001012
1013
1014 XXX - this list needs to get updated!
1015
Wolfgang Denk2aceea12013-03-23 23:50:31 +00001016- Regular expression support:
1017 CONFIG_REGEX
Wolfgang Denkec7fbf52013-10-04 17:43:24 +02001018 If this variable is defined, U-Boot is linked against
1019 the SLRE (Super Light Regular Expression) library,
1020 which adds regex support to some commands, as for
1021 example "env grep" and "setexpr".
Wolfgang Denk2aceea12013-03-23 23:50:31 +00001022
Simon Glass3d686442011-10-15 05:48:20 +00001023- Device tree:
1024 CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
1025 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will use a device tree
1026 to configure its devices, instead of relying on statically
1027 compiled #defines in the board file. This option is
1028 experimental and only available on a few boards. The device
1029 tree is available in the global data as gd->fdt_blob.
1030
Simon Glass5cb34db2011-10-24 19:15:31 +00001031 U-Boot needs to get its device tree from somewhere. This can
1032 be done using one of the two options below:
Simon Glass38d6b8d2011-10-15 05:48:21 +00001033
1034 CONFIG_OF_EMBED
1035 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will embed a device tree
1036 binary in its image. This device tree file should be in the
1037 board directory and called <soc>-<board>.dts. The binary file
1038 is then picked up in board_init_f() and made available through
1039 the global data structure as gd->blob.
Simon Glass3d686442011-10-15 05:48:20 +00001040
Simon Glass5cb34db2011-10-24 19:15:31 +00001041 CONFIG_OF_SEPARATE
1042 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will build a device tree
1043 binary. It will be called u-boot.dtb. Architecture-specific
1044 code will locate it at run-time. Generally this works by:
1045
1046 cat u-boot.bin u-boot.dtb >image.bin
1047
1048 and in fact, U-Boot does this for you, creating a file called
1049 u-boot-dtb.bin which is useful in the common case. You can
1050 still use the individual files if you need something more
1051 exotic.
1052
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001053- Watchdog:
1054 CONFIG_WATCHDOG
1055 If this variable is defined, it enables watchdog
Detlev Zundel6aa4d7b2011-04-27 05:25:59 +00001056 support for the SoC. There must be support in the SoC
1057 specific code for a watchdog. For the 8xx and 8260
1058 CPUs, the SIU Watchdog feature is enabled in the SYPCR
1059 register. When supported for a specific SoC is
1060 available, then no further board specific code should
1061 be needed to use it.
1062
1063 CONFIG_HW_WATCHDOG
1064 When using a watchdog circuitry external to the used
1065 SoC, then define this variable and provide board
1066 specific code for the "hw_watchdog_reset" function.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001067
stroeseb9c17c52003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001068- U-Boot Version:
1069 CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE
1070 If this variable is defined, an environment variable
1071 named "ver" is created by U-Boot showing the U-Boot
1072 version as printed by the "version" command.
Benoît Thébaudeauce9a1552012-08-13 15:01:14 +02001073 Any change to this variable will be reverted at the
1074 next reset.
stroeseb9c17c52003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001075
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001076- Real-Time Clock:
1077
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001078 When CONFIG_CMD_DATE is selected, the type of the RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001079 has to be selected, too. Define exactly one of the
1080 following options:
1081
1082 CONFIG_RTC_MPC8xx - use internal RTC of MPC8xx
1083 CONFIG_RTC_PCF8563 - use Philips PCF8563 RTC
Fabio Estevam3f8d1782011-10-24 06:44:15 +00001084 CONFIG_RTC_MC13XXX - use MC13783 or MC13892 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001085 CONFIG_RTC_MC146818 - use MC146818 RTC
wdenk1fe2c702003-03-06 21:55:29 +00001086 CONFIG_RTC_DS1307 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1307 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001087 CONFIG_RTC_DS1337 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1337 RTC
wdenk0893c472003-05-20 14:25:27 +00001088 CONFIG_RTC_DS1338 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1338 RTC
wdenkef5fe752003-03-12 10:41:04 +00001089 CONFIG_RTC_DS164x - use Dallas DS164x RTC
Tor Krillb27939b2008-03-15 15:40:26 +01001090 CONFIG_RTC_ISL1208 - use Intersil ISL1208 RTC
wdenkaeba06f2004-06-09 17:34:58 +00001091 CONFIG_RTC_MAX6900 - use Maxim, Inc. MAX6900 RTC
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001092 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_DS1337_NOOSC - Turn off the OSC output for DS1337
Heiko Schocher1f1b7012011-03-28 09:24:22 +02001093 CONFIG_SYS_RV3029_TCR - enable trickle charger on
1094 RV3029 RTC.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001095
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001096 Note that if the RTC uses I2C, then the I2C interface
1097 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
1098
Peter Tyser9902e422008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001099- GPIO Support:
1100 CONFIG_PCA953X - use NXP's PCA953X series I2C GPIO
Peter Tyser9902e422008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001101
Chris Packham9b383202010-12-19 10:12:13 +00001102 The CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PCA953X_WIDTH option specifies a list of
1103 chip-ngpio pairs that tell the PCA953X driver the number of
1104 pins supported by a particular chip.
1105
Peter Tyser9902e422008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001106 Note that if the GPIO device uses I2C, then the I2C interface
1107 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
1108
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001109- Timestamp Support:
1110
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001111 When CONFIG_TIMESTAMP is selected, the timestamp
1112 (date and time) of an image is printed by image
1113 commands like bootm or iminfo. This option is
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001114 automatically enabled when you select CONFIG_CMD_DATE .
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001115
Karl O. Pinc8b1f90a2012-08-16 06:20:15 +00001116- Partition Labels (disklabels) Supported:
1117 Zero or more of the following:
1118 CONFIG_MAC_PARTITION Apple's MacOS partition table.
1119 CONFIG_DOS_PARTITION MS Dos partition table, traditional on the
1120 Intel architecture, USB sticks, etc.
1121 CONFIG_ISO_PARTITION ISO partition table, used on CDROM etc.
1122 CONFIG_EFI_PARTITION GPT partition table, common when EFI is the
1123 bootloader. Note 2TB partition limit; see
1124 disk/part_efi.c
1125 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS Memory Technology Device partition table.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001126
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01001127 If IDE or SCSI support is enabled (CONFIG_CMD_IDE or
1128 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI) you must configure support for at
Karl O. Pinc8b1f90a2012-08-16 06:20:15 +00001129 least one non-MTD partition type as well.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001130
1131- IDE Reset method:
wdenk369d43d2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001132 CONFIG_IDE_RESET_ROUTINE - this is defined in several
1133 board configurations files but used nowhere!
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001134
wdenk369d43d2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001135 CONFIG_IDE_RESET - is this is defined, IDE Reset will
1136 be performed by calling the function
1137 ide_set_reset(int reset)
1138 which has to be defined in a board specific file
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001139
1140- ATAPI Support:
1141 CONFIG_ATAPI
1142
1143 Set this to enable ATAPI support.
1144
wdenkf602aa02004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001145- LBA48 Support
1146 CONFIG_LBA48
1147
1148 Set this to enable support for disks larger than 137GB
Heiko Schocher0f602e12009-12-03 11:21:21 +01001149 Also look at CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA.
wdenkf602aa02004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001150 Whithout these , LBA48 support uses 32bit variables and will 'only'
1151 support disks up to 2.1TB.
1152
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001153 CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA:
wdenkf602aa02004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001154 When enabled, makes the IDE subsystem use 64bit sector addresses.
1155 Default is 32bit.
1156
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001157- SCSI Support:
1158 At the moment only there is only support for the
1159 SYM53C8XX SCSI controller; define
1160 CONFIG_SCSI_SYM53C8XX to enable it.
1161
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001162 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN [8], CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID [7] and
1163 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_DEVICE [CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID *
1164 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN] can be adjusted to define the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001165 maximum numbers of LUNs, SCSI ID's and target
1166 devices.
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001167 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_SYM53C8XX_CCF to fix clock timing (80Mhz)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001168
Wolfgang Denkec7fbf52013-10-04 17:43:24 +02001169 The environment variable 'scsidevs' is set to the number of
1170 SCSI devices found during the last scan.
Stefan Reinauere50a10e2012-10-29 05:23:48 +00001171
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001172- NETWORK Support (PCI):
wdenk4e112c12003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001173 CONFIG_E1000
Kyle Moffett64b94dd2011-10-18 11:05:29 +00001174 Support for Intel 8254x/8257x gigabit chips.
1175
1176 CONFIG_E1000_SPI
1177 Utility code for direct access to the SPI bus on Intel 8257x.
1178 This does not do anything useful unless you set at least one
1179 of CONFIG_CMD_E1000 or CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC.
1180
1181 CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC
1182 Allow generic access to the SPI bus on the Intel 8257x, for
1183 example with the "sspi" command.
1184
1185 CONFIG_CMD_E1000
1186 Management command for E1000 devices. When used on devices
1187 with SPI support you can reprogram the EEPROM from U-Boot.
stroese94ef1cf2003-06-05 15:39:44 +00001188
Andre Schwarz68c2a302008-03-06 16:45:44 +01001189 CONFIG_E1000_FALLBACK_MAC
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001190 default MAC for empty EEPROM after production.
Andre Schwarz68c2a302008-03-06 16:45:44 +01001191
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001192 CONFIG_EEPRO100
1193 Support for Intel 82557/82559/82559ER chips.
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001194 Optional CONFIG_EEPRO100_SROM_WRITE enables EEPROM
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001195 write routine for first time initialisation.
1196
1197 CONFIG_TULIP
1198 Support for Digital 2114x chips.
1199 Optional CONFIG_TULIP_SELECT_MEDIA for board specific
1200 modem chip initialisation (KS8761/QS6611).
1201
1202 CONFIG_NATSEMI
1203 Support for National dp83815 chips.
1204
1205 CONFIG_NS8382X
1206 Support for National dp8382[01] gigabit chips.
1207
wdenkaa603362003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001208- NETWORK Support (other):
1209
Jens Scharsigdab7cb82010-01-23 12:03:45 +01001210 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC
1211 Support for AT91RM9200 EMAC.
1212
1213 CONFIG_RMII
1214 Define this to use reduced MII inteface
1215
1216 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC_QUIET
1217 If this defined, the driver is quiet.
1218 The driver doen't show link status messages.
1219
Rob Herringc9830dc2011-12-15 11:15:49 +00001220 CONFIG_CALXEDA_XGMAC
1221 Support for the Calxeda XGMAC device
1222
Ashok93fb8722012-10-15 06:20:47 +00001223 CONFIG_LAN91C96
wdenkaa603362003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001224 Support for SMSC's LAN91C96 chips.
1225
1226 CONFIG_LAN91C96_BASE
1227 Define this to hold the physical address
1228 of the LAN91C96's I/O space
1229
1230 CONFIG_LAN91C96_USE_32_BIT
1231 Define this to enable 32 bit addressing
1232
Ashok93fb8722012-10-15 06:20:47 +00001233 CONFIG_SMC91111
wdenk3c711762004-06-09 13:37:52 +00001234 Support for SMSC's LAN91C111 chip
1235
1236 CONFIG_SMC91111_BASE
1237 Define this to hold the physical address
1238 of the device (I/O space)
1239
1240 CONFIG_SMC_USE_32_BIT
1241 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1242
1243 CONFIG_SMC_USE_IOFUNCS
1244 Define this to use i/o functions instead of macros
1245 (some hardware wont work with macros)
1246
Heiko Schocher7d037f72011-11-15 10:00:04 -05001247 CONFIG_DRIVER_TI_EMAC
1248 Support for davinci emac
1249
1250 CONFIG_SYS_DAVINCI_EMAC_PHY_COUNT
1251 Define this if you have more then 3 PHYs.
1252
Macpaul Lin199c6252010-12-21 16:59:46 +08001253 CONFIG_FTGMAC100
1254 Support for Faraday's FTGMAC100 Gigabit SoC Ethernet
1255
1256 CONFIG_FTGMAC100_EGIGA
1257 Define this to use GE link update with gigabit PHY.
1258 Define this if FTGMAC100 is connected to gigabit PHY.
1259 If your system has 10/100 PHY only, it might not occur
1260 wrong behavior. Because PHY usually return timeout or
1261 useless data when polling gigabit status and gigabit
1262 control registers. This behavior won't affect the
1263 correctnessof 10/100 link speed update.
1264
Mike Rapoportf4761af2009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001265 CONFIG_SMC911X
Jens Gehrlein1dd48252008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001266 Support for SMSC's LAN911x and LAN921x chips
1267
Mike Rapoportf4761af2009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001268 CONFIG_SMC911X_BASE
Jens Gehrlein1dd48252008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001269 Define this to hold the physical address
1270 of the device (I/O space)
1271
Mike Rapoportf4761af2009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001272 CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT
Jens Gehrlein1dd48252008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001273 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1274
Mike Rapoportf4761af2009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001275 CONFIG_SMC911X_16_BIT
Jens Gehrlein1dd48252008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001276 Define this if data bus is 16 bits. If your processor
1277 automatically converts one 32 bit word to two 16 bit
Mike Rapoportf4761af2009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001278 words you may also try CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT.
Jens Gehrlein1dd48252008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001279
Yoshihiro Shimodaed4cea02011-01-27 10:06:03 +09001280 CONFIG_SH_ETHER
1281 Support for Renesas on-chip Ethernet controller
1282
1283 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_USE_PORT
1284 Define the number of ports to be used
1285
1286 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_PHY_ADDR
1287 Define the ETH PHY's address
1288
Yoshihiro Shimoda281aa052011-01-27 10:06:08 +09001289 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_CACHE_WRITEBACK
1290 If this option is set, the driver enables cache flush.
1291
Vadim Bendeburydac69642011-10-17 08:36:14 +00001292- TPM Support:
Che-liang Chiouacea5702013-04-12 11:04:34 +00001293 CONFIG_TPM
1294 Support TPM devices.
1295
Tom Wai-Hong Tame49fed52013-04-12 11:04:37 +00001296 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_I2C
1297 Support for i2c bus TPM devices. Only one device
1298 per system is supported at this time.
1299
1300 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_I2C_BUS_NUMBER
1301 Define the the i2c bus number for the TPM device
1302
1303 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_I2C_SLAVE_ADDRESS
1304 Define the TPM's address on the i2c bus
1305
1306 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_I2C_BURST_LIMITATION
1307 Define the burst count bytes upper limit
1308
Dirk Eibach20489092013-06-26 15:55:15 +02001309 CONFIG_TPM_ATMEL_TWI
1310 Support for Atmel TWI TPM device. Requires I2C support.
1311
Che-liang Chiouacea5702013-04-12 11:04:34 +00001312 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_LPC
Vadim Bendeburydac69642011-10-17 08:36:14 +00001313 Support for generic parallel port TPM devices. Only one device
1314 per system is supported at this time.
1315
1316 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_BASE_ADDRESS
1317 Base address where the generic TPM device is mapped
1318 to. Contemporary x86 systems usually map it at
1319 0xfed40000.
1320
Reinhard Pfau4fece432013-06-26 15:55:13 +02001321 CONFIG_CMD_TPM
1322 Add tpm monitor functions.
1323 Requires CONFIG_TPM. If CONFIG_TPM_AUTH_SESSIONS is set, also
1324 provides monitor access to authorized functions.
1325
1326 CONFIG_TPM
1327 Define this to enable the TPM support library which provides
1328 functional interfaces to some TPM commands.
1329 Requires support for a TPM device.
1330
1331 CONFIG_TPM_AUTH_SESSIONS
1332 Define this to enable authorized functions in the TPM library.
1333 Requires CONFIG_TPM and CONFIG_SHA1.
1334
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001335- USB Support:
1336 At the moment only the UHCI host controller is
wdenk369d43d2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001337 supported (PIP405, MIP405, MPC5200); define
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001338 CONFIG_USB_UHCI to enable it.
1339 define CONFIG_USB_KEYBOARD to enable the USB Keyboard
wdenkfb30b4c2004-10-09 22:44:59 +00001340 and define CONFIG_USB_STORAGE to enable the USB
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001341 storage devices.
1342 Note:
1343 Supported are USB Keyboards and USB Floppy drives
1344 (TEAC FD-05PUB).
wdenk369d43d2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001345 MPC5200 USB requires additional defines:
1346 CONFIG_USB_CLOCK
1347 for 528 MHz Clock: 0x0001bbbb
Eric Millbrandt02848522009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001348 CONFIG_PSC3_USB
1349 for USB on PSC3
wdenk369d43d2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001350 CONFIG_USB_CONFIG
1351 for differential drivers: 0x00001000
1352 for single ended drivers: 0x00005000
Eric Millbrandt02848522009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001353 for differential drivers on PSC3: 0x00000100
1354 for single ended drivers on PSC3: 0x00004100
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001355 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EVENT_POLL
Zhang Wei063f9ff2007-06-06 10:08:13 +02001356 May be defined to allow interrupt polling
1357 instead of using asynchronous interrupts
wdenk369d43d2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001358
Simon Glass5978cdb2012-02-27 10:52:47 +00001359 CONFIG_USB_EHCI_TXFIFO_THRESH enables setting of the
1360 txfilltuning field in the EHCI controller on reset.
1361
Kuo-Jung Su4e5923f2013-05-15 15:29:22 +08001362 CONFIG_USB_HUB_MIN_POWER_ON_DELAY defines the minimum
1363 interval for usb hub power-on delay.(minimum 100msec)
1364
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001365- USB Device:
1366 Define the below if you wish to use the USB console.
1367 Once firmware is rebuilt from a serial console issue the
1368 command "setenv stdin usbtty; setenv stdout usbtty" and
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001369 attach your USB cable. The Unix command "dmesg" should print
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001370 it has found a new device. The environment variable usbtty
1371 can be set to gserial or cdc_acm to enable your device to
Wolfgang Denke2601822006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001372 appear to a USB host as a Linux gserial device or a
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001373 Common Device Class Abstract Control Model serial device.
1374 If you select usbtty = gserial you should be able to enumerate
1375 a Linux host by
1376 # modprobe usbserial vendor=0xVendorID product=0xProductID
1377 else if using cdc_acm, simply setting the environment
1378 variable usbtty to be cdc_acm should suffice. The following
1379 might be defined in YourBoardName.h
Wolfgang Denke2601822006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001380
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001381 CONFIG_USB_DEVICE
1382 Define this to build a UDC device
1383
1384 CONFIG_USB_TTY
1385 Define this to have a tty type of device available to
1386 talk to the UDC device
Wolfgang Denke2601822006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001387
Vipin KUMARbdb17702012-03-26 15:38:06 +05301388 CONFIG_USBD_HS
1389 Define this to enable the high speed support for usb
1390 device and usbtty. If this feature is enabled, a routine
1391 int is_usbd_high_speed(void)
1392 also needs to be defined by the driver to dynamically poll
1393 whether the enumeration has succeded at high speed or full
1394 speed.
1395
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001396 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001397 Define this if you want stdin, stdout &/or stderr to
1398 be set to usbtty.
1399
1400 mpc8xx:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001401 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001402 Derive USB clock from external clock "blah"
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001403 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0x02
Wolfgang Denke2601822006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001404
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001405 CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001406 Derive USB clock from brgclk
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001407 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0x04
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001408
Wolfgang Denke2601822006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001409 If you have a USB-IF assigned VendorID then you may wish to
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001410 define your own vendor specific values either in BoardName.h
Wolfgang Denke2601822006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001411 or directly in usbd_vendor_info.h. If you don't define
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001412 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER, CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME,
1413 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID and CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID, then U-Boot
1414 should pretend to be a Linux device to it's target host.
1415
1416 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER
1417 Define this string as the name of your company for
1418 - CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER "my company"
Wolfgang Denke2601822006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001419
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001420 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME
1421 Define this string as the name of your product
1422 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME "acme usb device"
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001423
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001424 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID
1425 Define this as your assigned Vendor ID from the USB
1426 Implementors Forum. This *must* be a genuine Vendor ID
1427 to avoid polluting the USB namespace.
1428 - CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID 0xFFFF
Wolfgang Denke2601822006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001429
Wolfgang Denk3f0137b2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001430 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID
1431 Define this as the unique Product ID
1432 for your device
1433 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID 0xFFFF
Wolfgang Denke2601822006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001434
Przemyslaw Marczak06ef7cc2013-10-23 14:30:46 +02001435 Some USB device drivers may need to check USB cable attachment.
1436 In this case you can enable following config in BoardName.h:
1437 CONFIG_USB_CABLE_CHECK
1438 This enables function definition:
1439 - usb_cable_connected() in include/usb.h
1440 Implementation of this function is board-specific.
1441
Igor Grinbergac5f6ee2011-12-12 12:08:35 +02001442- ULPI Layer Support:
1443 The ULPI (UTMI Low Pin (count) Interface) PHYs are supported via
1444 the generic ULPI layer. The generic layer accesses the ULPI PHY
1445 via the platform viewport, so you need both the genric layer and
1446 the viewport enabled. Currently only Chipidea/ARC based
1447 viewport is supported.
1448 To enable the ULPI layer support, define CONFIG_USB_ULPI and
1449 CONFIG_USB_ULPI_VIEWPORT in your board configuration file.
Lucas Stachf31e4112012-10-01 00:44:35 +02001450 If your ULPI phy needs a different reference clock than the
1451 standard 24 MHz then you have to define CONFIG_ULPI_REF_CLK to
1452 the appropriate value in Hz.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001453
wdenk7a428cc2003-06-15 22:40:42 +00001454- MMC Support:
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001455 The MMC controller on the Intel PXA is supported. To
1456 enable this define CONFIG_MMC. The MMC can be
1457 accessed from the boot prompt by mapping the device
wdenk7a428cc2003-06-15 22:40:42 +00001458 to physical memory similar to flash. Command line is
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001459 enabled with CONFIG_CMD_MMC. The MMC driver also works with
1460 the FAT fs. This is enabled with CONFIG_CMD_FAT.
wdenk7a428cc2003-06-15 22:40:42 +00001461
Yoshihiro Shimodadb7717b2011-07-04 22:21:22 +00001462 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF
1463 Support for Renesas on-chip MMCIF controller
1464
1465 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_ADDR
1466 Define the base address of MMCIF registers
1467
1468 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_CLK
1469 Define the clock frequency for MMCIF
1470
Tom Rini58a8d322013-03-14 05:32:47 +00001471- USB Device Firmware Update (DFU) class support:
1472 CONFIG_DFU_FUNCTION
1473 This enables the USB portion of the DFU USB class
1474
1475 CONFIG_CMD_DFU
1476 This enables the command "dfu" which is used to have
1477 U-Boot create a DFU class device via USB. This command
1478 requires that the "dfu_alt_info" environment variable be
1479 set and define the alt settings to expose to the host.
1480
1481 CONFIG_DFU_MMC
1482 This enables support for exposing (e)MMC devices via DFU.
1483
Pantelis Antonioucf14d0d2013-03-14 05:32:52 +00001484 CONFIG_DFU_NAND
1485 This enables support for exposing NAND devices via DFU.
1486
Afzal Mohammede3c687a2013-09-18 01:15:24 +05301487 CONFIG_DFU_RAM
1488 This enables support for exposing RAM via DFU.
1489 Note: DFU spec refer to non-volatile memory usage, but
1490 allow usages beyond the scope of spec - here RAM usage,
1491 one that would help mostly the developer.
1492
Heiko Schochera2f831e2013-06-12 06:05:51 +02001493 CONFIG_SYS_DFU_DATA_BUF_SIZE
1494 Dfu transfer uses a buffer before writing data to the
1495 raw storage device. Make the size (in bytes) of this buffer
1496 configurable. The size of this buffer is also configurable
1497 through the "dfu_bufsiz" environment variable.
1498
Pantelis Antonioua6e788d2013-03-14 05:32:48 +00001499 CONFIG_SYS_DFU_MAX_FILE_SIZE
1500 When updating files rather than the raw storage device,
1501 we use a static buffer to copy the file into and then write
1502 the buffer once we've been given the whole file. Define
1503 this to the maximum filesize (in bytes) for the buffer.
1504 Default is 4 MiB if undefined.
1505
wdenkda04a8b2004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001506- Journaling Flash filesystem support:
1507 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_OFF, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_SIZE,
1508 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_DEV
1509 Define these for a default partition on a NAND device
1510
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001511 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_SECTOR,
1512 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_BANK, CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_NUM_BANKS
wdenkda04a8b2004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001513 Define these for a default partition on a NOR device
1514
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001515 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_CUSTOM_PART
wdenkda04a8b2004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001516 Define this to create an own partition. You have to provide a
1517 function struct part_info* jffs2_part_info(int part_num)
1518
1519 If you define only one JFFS2 partition you may also want to
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001520 #define CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_SINGLE_PART 1
wdenkda04a8b2004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001521 to disable the command chpart. This is the default when you
1522 have not defined a custom partition
1523
Donggeun Kim8f814002011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001524- FAT(File Allocation Table) filesystem write function support:
1525 CONFIG_FAT_WRITE
Donggeun Kimb44c8ab2012-03-22 04:38:56 +00001526
1527 Define this to enable support for saving memory data as a
1528 file in FAT formatted partition.
1529
1530 This will also enable the command "fatwrite" enabling the
1531 user to write files to FAT.
Donggeun Kim8f814002011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001532
Gabe Black7f8574c2012-10-12 14:26:11 +00001533CBFS (Coreboot Filesystem) support
1534 CONFIG_CMD_CBFS
1535
1536 Define this to enable support for reading from a Coreboot
1537 filesystem. Available commands are cbfsinit, cbfsinfo, cbfsls
1538 and cbfsload.
1539
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001540- Keyboard Support:
1541 CONFIG_ISA_KEYBOARD
1542
1543 Define this to enable standard (PC-Style) keyboard
1544 support
1545
1546 CONFIG_I8042_KBD
1547 Standard PC keyboard driver with US (is default) and
1548 GERMAN key layout (switch via environment 'keymap=de') support.
1549 Export function i8042_kbd_init, i8042_tstc and i8042_getc
1550 for cfb_console. Supports cursor blinking.
1551
Hung-ying Tyan4a48bcf2013-05-15 18:27:32 +08001552 CONFIG_CROS_EC_KEYB
1553 Enables a Chrome OS keyboard using the CROS_EC interface.
1554 This uses CROS_EC to communicate with a second microcontroller
1555 which provides key scans on request.
1556
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001557- Video support:
1558 CONFIG_VIDEO
1559
1560 Define this to enable video support (for output to
1561 video).
1562
1563 CONFIG_VIDEO_CT69000
1564
1565 Enable Chips & Technologies 69000 Video chip
1566
1567 CONFIG_VIDEO_SMI_LYNXEM
wdenkd3602132004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001568 Enable Silicon Motion SMI 712/710/810 Video chip. The
wdenkaea86e42004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001569 video output is selected via environment 'videoout'
1570 (1 = LCD and 2 = CRT). If videoout is undefined, CRT is
1571 assumed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001572
wdenkd3602132004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001573 For the CT69000 and SMI_LYNXEM drivers, videomode is
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001574 selected via environment 'videomode'. Two different ways
wdenkaea86e42004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001575 are possible:
1576 - "videomode=num" 'num' is a standard LiLo mode numbers.
wdenk05939202004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001577 Following standard modes are supported (* is default):
wdenkaea86e42004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001578
1579 Colors 640x480 800x600 1024x768 1152x864 1280x1024
1580 -------------+---------------------------------------------
1581 8 bits | 0x301* 0x303 0x305 0x161 0x307
1582 15 bits | 0x310 0x313 0x316 0x162 0x319
1583 16 bits | 0x311 0x314 0x317 0x163 0x31A
1584 24 bits | 0x312 0x315 0x318 ? 0x31B
1585 -------------+---------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001586 (i.e. setenv videomode 317; saveenv; reset;)
1587
wdenkd3602132004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001588 - "videomode=bootargs" all the video parameters are parsed
Marcel Ziswileraea68562007-12-30 03:30:46 +01001589 from the bootargs. (See drivers/video/videomodes.c)
wdenkaea86e42004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001590
1591
stroeseb9c17c52003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001592 CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001593 Enable Epson SED13806 driver. This driver supports 8bpp
wdenk9dd2b882002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001594 and 16bpp modes defined by CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_8BPP
1595 or CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_16BPP
1596
Timur Tabi020edd22011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001597 CONFIG_FSL_DIU_FB
Wolfgang Denk825223d2011-09-11 21:24:09 +02001598 Enable the Freescale DIU video driver. Reference boards for
Timur Tabi020edd22011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001599 SOCs that have a DIU should define this macro to enable DIU
1600 support, and should also define these other macros:
1601
1602 CONFIG_SYS_DIU_ADDR
1603 CONFIG_VIDEO
1604 CONFIG_CMD_BMP
1605 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
1606 CONFIG_VIDEO_SW_CURSOR
1607 CONFIG_VGA_AS_SINGLE_DEVICE
1608 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
1609 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO
1610
Timur Tabi32f709e2011-04-11 14:18:22 -05001611 The DIU driver will look for the 'video-mode' environment
1612 variable, and if defined, enable the DIU as a console during
1613 boot. See the documentation file README.video for a
1614 description of this variable.
Timur Tabi020edd22011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001615
Simon Glass54df8ce2012-12-03 13:59:47 +00001616 CONFIG_VIDEO_VGA
1617
1618 Enable the VGA video / BIOS for x86. The alternative if you
1619 are using coreboot is to use the coreboot frame buffer
1620 driver.
1621
1622
wdenk4e112c12003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001623- Keyboard Support:
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001624 CONFIG_KEYBOARD
wdenk4e112c12003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001625
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001626 Define this to enable a custom keyboard support.
1627 This simply calls drv_keyboard_init() which must be
1628 defined in your board-specific files.
1629 The only board using this so far is RBC823.
wdenk9dd2b882002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001630
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001631- LCD Support: CONFIG_LCD
1632
1633 Define this to enable LCD support (for output to LCD
1634 display); also select one of the supported displays
1635 by defining one of these:
1636
Stelian Popf6f86652008-05-09 21:57:18 +02001637 CONFIG_ATMEL_LCD:
1638
1639 HITACHI TX09D70VM1CCA, 3.5", 240x320.
1640
wdenkc0d54ae2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001641 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448AC33:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001642
wdenkc0d54ae2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001643 NEC NL6448AC33-18. Active, color, single scan.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001644
wdenkc0d54ae2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001645 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC20
1646
1647 NEC NL6448BC20-08. 6.5", 640x480.
1648 Active, color, single scan.
1649
1650 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC33_54
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001651
wdenkc0d54ae2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001652 NEC NL6448BC33-54. 10.4", 640x480.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001653 Active, color, single scan.
1654
1655 CONFIG_SHARP_16x9
1656
1657 Sharp 320x240. Active, color, single scan.
1658 It isn't 16x9, and I am not sure what it is.
1659
1660 CONFIG_SHARP_LQ64D341
1661
1662 Sharp LQ64D341 display, 640x480.
1663 Active, color, single scan.
1664
1665 CONFIG_HLD1045
1666
1667 HLD1045 display, 640x480.
1668 Active, color, single scan.
1669
1670 CONFIG_OPTREX_BW
1671
1672 Optrex CBL50840-2 NF-FW 99 22 M5
1673 or
1674 Hitachi LMG6912RPFC-00T
1675 or
1676 Hitachi SP14Q002
1677
1678 320x240. Black & white.
1679
1680 Normally display is black on white background; define
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001681 CONFIG_SYS_WHITE_ON_BLACK to get it inverted.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001682
Simon Glass599a4df2012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001683 CONFIG_LCD_ALIGNMENT
1684
1685 Normally the LCD is page-aligned (tyically 4KB). If this is
1686 defined then the LCD will be aligned to this value instead.
1687 For ARM it is sometimes useful to use MMU_SECTION_SIZE
1688 here, since it is cheaper to change data cache settings on
1689 a per-section basis.
1690
Simon Glassaf3e2802012-10-17 13:24:59 +00001691 CONFIG_CONSOLE_SCROLL_LINES
1692
1693 When the console need to be scrolled, this is the number of
1694 lines to scroll by. It defaults to 1. Increasing this makes
1695 the console jump but can help speed up operation when scrolling
1696 is slow.
Simon Glass599a4df2012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001697
Tom Wai-Hong Tam79926a42012-09-28 15:11:16 +00001698 CONFIG_LCD_BMP_RLE8
1699
1700 Support drawing of RLE8-compressed bitmaps on the LCD.
1701
Tom Wai-Hong Tam6664f202012-12-05 14:46:40 +00001702 CONFIG_I2C_EDID
1703
1704 Enables an 'i2c edid' command which can read EDID
1705 information over I2C from an attached LCD display.
1706
wdenkeb20ad32003-09-05 23:19:14 +00001707- Splash Screen Support: CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN
wdenk92bbe3f2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001708
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001709 If this option is set, the environment is checked for
1710 a variable "splashimage". If found, the usual display
1711 of logo, copyright and system information on the LCD
wdenk01686632004-06-30 22:59:18 +00001712 is suppressed and the BMP image at the address
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001713 specified in "splashimage" is loaded instead. The
1714 console is redirected to the "nulldev", too. This
1715 allows for a "silent" boot where a splash screen is
1716 loaded very quickly after power-on.
wdenk92bbe3f2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001717
Nikita Kiryanov2f3e2ca2013-02-24 21:28:43 +00001718 CONFIG_SPLASHIMAGE_GUARD
1719
1720 If this option is set, then U-Boot will prevent the environment
1721 variable "splashimage" from being set to a problematic address
1722 (see README.displaying-bmps and README.arm-unaligned-accesses).
1723 This option is useful for targets where, due to alignment
1724 restrictions, an improperly aligned BMP image will cause a data
1725 abort. If you think you will not have problems with unaligned
1726 accesses (for example because your toolchain prevents them)
1727 there is no need to set this option.
1728
Matthias Weisser53884182009-07-09 16:07:30 +02001729 CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN_ALIGN
1730
1731 If this option is set the splash image can be freely positioned
1732 on the screen. Environment variable "splashpos" specifies the
1733 position as "x,y". If a positive number is given it is used as
1734 number of pixel from left/top. If a negative number is given it
1735 is used as number of pixel from right/bottom. You can also
1736 specify 'm' for centering the image.
1737
1738 Example:
1739 setenv splashpos m,m
1740 => image at center of screen
1741
1742 setenv splashpos 30,20
1743 => image at x = 30 and y = 20
1744
1745 setenv splashpos -10,m
1746 => vertically centered image
1747 at x = dspWidth - bmpWidth - 9
1748
Stefan Roesed9d97742005-09-22 09:04:17 +02001749- Gzip compressed BMP image support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_GZIP
1750
1751 If this option is set, additionally to standard BMP
1752 images, gzipped BMP images can be displayed via the
1753 splashscreen support or the bmp command.
1754
Anatolij Gustschin6b4e4fc2010-03-15 14:50:25 +01001755- Run length encoded BMP image (RLE8) support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_RLE8
1756
1757 If this option is set, 8-bit RLE compressed BMP images
1758 can be displayed via the splashscreen support or the
1759 bmp command.
1760
Lei Wene4e248d2012-09-28 04:26:47 +00001761- Do compresssing for memory range:
1762 CONFIG_CMD_ZIP
1763
1764 If this option is set, it would use zlib deflate method
1765 to compress the specified memory at its best effort.
1766
wdenk710e3502003-08-29 20:57:53 +00001767- Compression support:
Kees Cook5b06e642013-08-16 07:59:12 -07001768 CONFIG_GZIP
1769
1770 Enabled by default to support gzip compressed images.
1771
wdenk710e3502003-08-29 20:57:53 +00001772 CONFIG_BZIP2
1773
1774 If this option is set, support for bzip2 compressed
1775 images is included. If not, only uncompressed and gzip
1776 compressed images are supported.
1777
wdenk9c53f402003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001778 NOTE: the bzip2 algorithm requires a lot of RAM, so
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001779 the malloc area (as defined by CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN) should
wdenk9c53f402003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001780 be at least 4MB.
wdenk92bbe3f2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001781
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellini35afc062008-09-08 02:46:13 +02001782 CONFIG_LZMA
1783
1784 If this option is set, support for lzma compressed
1785 images is included.
1786
1787 Note: The LZMA algorithm adds between 2 and 4KB of code and it
1788 requires an amount of dynamic memory that is given by the
1789 formula:
1790
1791 (1846 + 768 << (lc + lp)) * sizeof(uint16)
1792
1793 Where lc and lp stand for, respectively, Literal context bits
1794 and Literal pos bits.
1795
1796 This value is upper-bounded by 14MB in the worst case. Anyway,
1797 for a ~4MB large kernel image, we have lc=3 and lp=0 for a
1798 total amount of (1846 + 768 << (3 + 0)) * 2 = ~41KB... that is
1799 a very small buffer.
1800
1801 Use the lzmainfo tool to determinate the lc and lp values and
1802 then calculate the amount of needed dynamic memory (ensuring
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001803 the appropriate CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN value).
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellini35afc062008-09-08 02:46:13 +02001804
Kees Cook5b06e642013-08-16 07:59:12 -07001805 CONFIG_LZO
1806
1807 If this option is set, support for LZO compressed images
1808 is included.
1809
wdenk0e2bd9c2004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001810- MII/PHY support:
1811 CONFIG_PHY_ADDR
1812
1813 The address of PHY on MII bus.
1814
1815 CONFIG_PHY_CLOCK_FREQ (ppc4xx)
1816
1817 The clock frequency of the MII bus
1818
1819 CONFIG_PHY_GIGE
1820
1821 If this option is set, support for speed/duplex
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001822 detection of gigabit PHY is included.
wdenk0e2bd9c2004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001823
1824 CONFIG_PHY_RESET_DELAY
1825
1826 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1827 reset before any MII register access is possible.
1828 For such PHY, set this option to the usec delay
1829 required. (minimum 300usec for LXT971A)
1830
1831 CONFIG_PHY_CMD_DELAY (ppc4xx)
1832
1833 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1834 command issued before MII status register can be read
1835
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001836- Ethernet address:
1837 CONFIG_ETHADDR
richardretanubune5167f12008-09-29 18:28:23 -04001838 CONFIG_ETH1ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001839 CONFIG_ETH2ADDR
1840 CONFIG_ETH3ADDR
richardretanubune5167f12008-09-29 18:28:23 -04001841 CONFIG_ETH4ADDR
1842 CONFIG_ETH5ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001843
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001844 Define a default value for Ethernet address to use
1845 for the respective Ethernet interface, in case this
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001846 is not determined automatically.
1847
1848- IP address:
1849 CONFIG_IPADDR
1850
1851 Define a default value for the IP address to use for
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001852 the default Ethernet interface, in case this is not
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001853 determined through e.g. bootp.
Wolfgang Denk26da2992011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001854 (Environment variable "ipaddr")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001855
1856- Server IP address:
1857 CONFIG_SERVERIP
1858
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001859 Defines a default value for the IP address of a TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001860 server to contact when using the "tftboot" command.
Wolfgang Denk26da2992011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001861 (Environment variable "serverip")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001862
Robin Getz470a6d42009-07-21 12:15:28 -04001863 CONFIG_KEEP_SERVERADDR
1864
1865 Keeps the server's MAC address, in the env 'serveraddr'
1866 for passing to bootargs (like Linux's netconsole option)
1867
Wolfgang Denk26da2992011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001868- Gateway IP address:
1869 CONFIG_GATEWAYIP
1870
1871 Defines a default value for the IP address of the
1872 default router where packets to other networks are
1873 sent to.
1874 (Environment variable "gatewayip")
1875
1876- Subnet mask:
1877 CONFIG_NETMASK
1878
1879 Defines a default value for the subnet mask (or
1880 routing prefix) which is used to determine if an IP
1881 address belongs to the local subnet or needs to be
1882 forwarded through a router.
1883 (Environment variable "netmask")
1884
David Updegraff7280da72007-06-11 10:41:07 -05001885- Multicast TFTP Mode:
1886 CONFIG_MCAST_TFTP
1887
1888 Defines whether you want to support multicast TFTP as per
1889 rfc-2090; for example to work with atftp. Lets lots of targets
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001890 tftp down the same boot image concurrently. Note: the Ethernet
David Updegraff7280da72007-06-11 10:41:07 -05001891 driver in use must provide a function: mcast() to join/leave a
1892 multicast group.
1893
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001894- BOOTP Recovery Mode:
1895 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY
1896
1897 If you have many targets in a network that try to
1898 boot using BOOTP, you may want to avoid that all
1899 systems send out BOOTP requests at precisely the same
1900 moment (which would happen for instance at recovery
1901 from a power failure, when all systems will try to
1902 boot, thus flooding the BOOTP server. Defining
1903 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY causes a random delay to be
1904 inserted before sending out BOOTP requests. The
Wolfgang Denkb65aaf92007-08-06 23:21:05 +02001905 following delays are inserted then:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001906
1907 1st BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 1 sec
1908 2nd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 2 sec
1909 3rd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 4 sec
1910 4th and following
1911 BOOTP requests: delay 0 ... 8 sec
1912
stroesee0aadfb2003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001913- DHCP Advanced Options:
Jon Loeliger5336a762007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001914 You can fine tune the DHCP functionality by defining
1915 CONFIG_BOOTP_* symbols:
stroesee0aadfb2003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001916
Jon Loeliger5336a762007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001917 CONFIG_BOOTP_SUBNETMASK
1918 CONFIG_BOOTP_GATEWAY
1919 CONFIG_BOOTP_HOSTNAME
1920 CONFIG_BOOTP_NISDOMAIN
1921 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTPATH
1922 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTFILESIZE
1923 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
1924 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2
1925 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME
1926 CONFIG_BOOTP_NTPSERVER
1927 CONFIG_BOOTP_TIMEOFFSET
1928 CONFIG_BOOTP_VENDOREX
Joe Hershberger8ca7fa02012-05-23 07:59:19 +00001929 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL
stroesee0aadfb2003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001930
Wilson Callan22bcd6e2007-07-28 10:56:13 -04001931 CONFIG_BOOTP_SERVERIP - TFTP server will be the serverip
1932 environment variable, not the BOOTP server.
stroesee0aadfb2003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001933
Joe Hershberger8ca7fa02012-05-23 07:59:19 +00001934 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL - If the DHCP server is not found
1935 after the configured retry count, the call will fail
1936 instead of starting over. This can be used to fail over
1937 to Link-local IP address configuration if the DHCP server
1938 is not available.
1939
stroesee0aadfb2003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001940 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 - If a DHCP client requests the DNS
1941 serverip from a DHCP server, it is possible that more
1942 than one DNS serverip is offered to the client.
1943 If CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 is enabled, the secondary DNS
1944 serverip will be stored in the additional environment
1945 variable "dnsip2". The first DNS serverip is always
1946 stored in the variable "dnsip", when CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
Jon Loeliger5336a762007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001947 is defined.
stroesee0aadfb2003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001948
1949 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME - Some DHCP servers are capable
1950 to do a dynamic update of a DNS server. To do this, they
1951 need the hostname of the DHCP requester.
Wilson Callan22bcd6e2007-07-28 10:56:13 -04001952 If CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME is defined, the content
Jon Loeliger5336a762007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001953 of the "hostname" environment variable is passed as
1954 option 12 to the DHCP server.
stroesee0aadfb2003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001955
Aras Vaichas72aa3f32008-03-26 09:43:57 +11001956 CONFIG_BOOTP_DHCP_REQUEST_DELAY
1957
1958 A 32bit value in microseconds for a delay between
1959 receiving a "DHCP Offer" and sending the "DHCP Request".
1960 This fixes a problem with certain DHCP servers that don't
1961 respond 100% of the time to a "DHCP request". E.g. On an
1962 AT91RM9200 processor running at 180MHz, this delay needed
1963 to be *at least* 15,000 usec before a Windows Server 2003
1964 DHCP server would reply 100% of the time. I recommend at
1965 least 50,000 usec to be safe. The alternative is to hope
1966 that one of the retries will be successful but note that
1967 the DHCP timeout and retry process takes a longer than
1968 this delay.
1969
Joe Hershbergerb35a3a62012-05-23 08:00:12 +00001970 - Link-local IP address negotiation:
1971 Negotiate with other link-local clients on the local network
1972 for an address that doesn't require explicit configuration.
1973 This is especially useful if a DHCP server cannot be guaranteed
1974 to exist in all environments that the device must operate.
1975
1976 See doc/README.link-local for more information.
1977
wdenk145d2c12004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001978 - CDP Options:
wdenk05939202004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001979 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID
wdenk145d2c12004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001980
1981 The device id used in CDP trigger frames.
1982
1983 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID_PREFIX
1984
1985 A two character string which is prefixed to the MAC address
1986 of the device.
1987
1988 CONFIG_CDP_PORT_ID
1989
1990 A printf format string which contains the ascii name of
1991 the port. Normally is set to "eth%d" which sets
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001992 eth0 for the first Ethernet, eth1 for the second etc.
wdenk145d2c12004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001993
1994 CONFIG_CDP_CAPABILITIES
1995
1996 A 32bit integer which indicates the device capabilities;
1997 0x00000010 for a normal host which does not forwards.
1998
1999 CONFIG_CDP_VERSION
2000
2001 An ascii string containing the version of the software.
2002
2003 CONFIG_CDP_PLATFORM
2004
2005 An ascii string containing the name of the platform.
2006
2007 CONFIG_CDP_TRIGGER
2008
2009 A 32bit integer sent on the trigger.
2010
2011 CONFIG_CDP_POWER_CONSUMPTION
2012
2013 A 16bit integer containing the power consumption of the
2014 device in .1 of milliwatts.
2015
2016 CONFIG_CDP_APPLIANCE_VLAN_TYPE
2017
2018 A byte containing the id of the VLAN.
2019
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002020- Status LED: CONFIG_STATUS_LED
2021
2022 Several configurations allow to display the current
2023 status using a LED. For instance, the LED will blink
2024 fast while running U-Boot code, stop blinking as
2025 soon as a reply to a BOOTP request was received, and
2026 start blinking slow once the Linux kernel is running
2027 (supported by a status LED driver in the Linux
2028 kernel). Defining CONFIG_STATUS_LED enables this
2029 feature in U-Boot.
2030
Igor Grinberg4997a9e2013-11-08 01:03:50 +02002031 Additional options:
2032
2033 CONFIG_GPIO_LED
2034 The status LED can be connected to a GPIO pin.
2035 In such cases, the gpio_led driver can be used as a
2036 status LED backend implementation. Define CONFIG_GPIO_LED
2037 to include the gpio_led driver in the U-Boot binary.
2038
Igor Grinberg203bd9f2013-11-08 01:03:52 +02002039 CONFIG_GPIO_LED_INVERTED_TABLE
2040 Some GPIO connected LEDs may have inverted polarity in which
2041 case the GPIO high value corresponds to LED off state and
2042 GPIO low value corresponds to LED on state.
2043 In such cases CONFIG_GPIO_LED_INVERTED_TABLE may be defined
2044 with a list of GPIO LEDs that have inverted polarity.
2045
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002046- CAN Support: CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER
2047
2048 Defining CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER enables CAN driver support
2049 on those systems that support this (optional)
2050 feature, like the TQM8xxL modules.
2051
Heiko Schochere0e55bc2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002052- I2C Support: CONFIG_SYS_I2C
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002053
Heiko Schochere0e55bc2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002054 This enable the NEW i2c subsystem, and will allow you to use
2055 i2c commands at the u-boot command line (as long as you set
2056 CONFIG_CMD_I2C in CONFIG_COMMANDS) and communicate with i2c
2057 based realtime clock chips or other i2c devices. See
2058 common/cmd_i2c.c for a description of the command line
2059 interface.
2060
2061 ported i2c driver to the new framework:
Heiko Schocher479a4cf2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002062 - drivers/i2c/soft_i2c.c:
2063 - activate first bus with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT define
2064 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE
2065 for defining speed and slave address
2066 - activate second bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS2 define
2067 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_2 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_2
2068 for defining speed and slave address
2069 - activate third bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS3 define
2070 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_3 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_3
2071 for defining speed and slave address
2072 - activate fourth bus with I2C_SOFT_DECLARATIONS4 define
2073 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SPEED_4 and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT_SLAVE_4
2074 for defining speed and slave address
Heiko Schochere0e55bc2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002075
Heiko Schocherf2850742012-10-24 13:48:22 +02002076 - drivers/i2c/fsl_i2c.c:
2077 - activate i2c driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_FSL
2078 define CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_OFFSET for setting the register
2079 offset CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_SPEED for the i2c speed and
2080 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C_SLAVE for the slave addr of the first
2081 bus.
Wolfgang Denkec7fbf52013-10-04 17:43:24 +02002082 - If your board supports a second fsl i2c bus, define
Heiko Schocherf2850742012-10-24 13:48:22 +02002083 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_OFFSET for the register offset
2084 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_SPEED for the speed and
2085 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_I2C2_SLAVE for the slave address of the
2086 second bus.
2087
Simon Glass026fefb2012-10-30 07:28:53 +00002088 - drivers/i2c/tegra_i2c.c:
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu045acfa2013-10-11 16:23:53 +09002089 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_TEGRA
2090 - This driver adds 4 i2c buses with a fix speed from
2091 100000 and the slave addr 0!
Simon Glass026fefb2012-10-30 07:28:53 +00002092
Dirk Eibach42b204f2013-04-25 02:40:01 +00002093 - drivers/i2c/ppc4xx_i2c.c
2094 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX
2095 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX_CH0 activate hardware channel 0
2096 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PPC4XX_CH1 activate hardware channel 1
2097
trema49f40a2013-09-21 18:13:35 +02002098 - drivers/i2c/i2c_mxc.c
2099 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MXC
2100 - define speed for bus 1 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C1_SPEED
2101 - define slave for bus 1 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C1_SLAVE
2102 - define speed for bus 2 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C2_SPEED
2103 - define slave for bus 2 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C2_SLAVE
2104 - define speed for bus 3 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C3_SPEED
2105 - define slave for bus 3 with CONFIG_SYS_MXC_I2C3_SLAVE
2106 If thoses defines are not set, default value is 100000
2107 for speed, and 0 for slave.
2108
Nobuhiro Iwamatsue94ea2f2013-09-27 16:58:30 +09002109 - drivers/i2c/rcar_i2c.c:
2110 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_RCAR
2111 - This driver adds 4 i2c buses
2112
2113 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C0_BASE for setting the register channel 0
2114 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C0_SPEED for for the speed channel 0
2115 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C1_BASE for setting the register channel 1
2116 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C1_SPEED for for the speed channel 1
2117 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C2_BASE for setting the register channel 2
2118 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C2_SPEED for for the speed channel 2
2119 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C3_BASE for setting the register channel 3
2120 - CONFIG_SYS_RCAR_I2C3_SPEED for for the speed channel 3
2121 - CONFIF_SYS_RCAR_I2C_NUM_CONTROLLERS for number of i2c buses
2122
Nobuhiro Iwamatsu12240102013-10-29 13:33:51 +09002123 - drivers/i2c/sh_i2c.c:
2124 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH
2125 - This driver adds from 2 to 5 i2c buses
2126
2127 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE0 for setting the register channel 0
2128 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED0 for for the speed channel 0
2129 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE1 for setting the register channel 1
2130 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED1 for for the speed channel 1
2131 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE2 for setting the register channel 2
2132 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED2 for for the speed channel 2
2133 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE3 for setting the register channel 3
2134 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED3 for for the speed channel 3
2135 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE4 for setting the register channel 4
2136 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED4 for for the speed channel 4
2137 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_BASE5 for setting the register channel 5
2138 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SH_SPEED5 for for the speed channel 5
2139 - CONFIF_SYS_I2C_SH_NUM_CONTROLLERS for nummber of i2c buses
2140
Heiko Schocherf53f2b82013-10-22 11:03:18 +02002141 - drivers/i2c/omap24xx_i2c.c
2142 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_OMAP24XX
2143 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED speed channel 0
2144 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE slave addr channel 0
2145 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED1 speed channel 1
2146 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE1 slave addr channel 1
2147 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED2 speed channel 2
2148 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE2 slave addr channel 2
2149 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED3 speed channel 3
2150 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE3 slave addr channel 3
2151 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SPEED4 speed channel 4
2152 - CONFIG_SYS_OMAP24_I2C_SLAVE4 slave addr channel 4
2153
Heiko Schocher465819a2013-11-08 07:30:53 +01002154 - drivers/i2c/zynq_i2c.c
2155 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ
2156 - set CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ_SPEED for speed setting
2157 - set CONFIG_SYS_I2C_ZYNQ_SLAVE for slave addr
2158
Naveen Krishna Ch5d5efd32013-12-06 12:12:38 +05302159 - drivers/i2c/s3c24x0_i2c.c:
2160 - activate this driver with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_S3C24X0
2161 - This driver adds i2c buses (11 for Exynos5250, Exynos5420
2162 9 i2c buses for Exynos4 and 1 for S3C24X0 SoCs from Samsung)
2163 with a fix speed from 100000 and the slave addr 0!
2164
Heiko Schochere0e55bc2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002165 additional defines:
2166
2167 CONFIG_SYS_NUM_I2C_BUSES
2168 Hold the number of i2c busses you want to use. If you
2169 don't use/have i2c muxes on your i2c bus, this
2170 is equal to CONFIG_SYS_NUM_I2C_ADAPTERS, and you can
2171 omit this define.
2172
2173 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DIRECT_BUS
2174 define this, if you don't use i2c muxes on your hardware.
2175 if CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS is not defined or == 0 you can
2176 omit this define.
2177
2178 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS
2179 define how many muxes are maximal consecutively connected
2180 on one i2c bus. If you not use i2c muxes, omit this
2181 define.
2182
2183 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BUSES
2184 hold a list of busses you want to use, only used if
2185 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DIRECT_BUS is not defined, for example
2186 a board with CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MAX_HOPS = 1 and
2187 CONFIG_SYS_NUM_I2C_BUSES = 9:
2188
2189 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BUSES {{0, {I2C_NULL_HOP}}, \
2190 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 1}}}, \
2191 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 2}}}, \
2192 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 3}}}, \
2193 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 4}}}, \
2194 {0, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9547, 0x70, 5}}}, \
2195 {1, {I2C_NULL_HOP}}, \
2196 {1, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9544, 0x72, 1}}}, \
2197 {1, {{I2C_MUX_PCA9544, 0x72, 2}}}, \
2198 }
2199
2200 which defines
2201 bus 0 on adapter 0 without a mux
Heiko Schocher479a4cf2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002202 bus 1 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 1
2203 bus 2 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 2
2204 bus 3 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 3
2205 bus 4 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 4
2206 bus 5 on adapter 0 with a PCA9547 on address 0x70 port 5
Heiko Schochere0e55bc2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002207 bus 6 on adapter 1 without a mux
Heiko Schocher479a4cf2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002208 bus 7 on adapter 1 with a PCA9544 on address 0x72 port 1
2209 bus 8 on adapter 1 with a PCA9544 on address 0x72 port 2
Heiko Schochere0e55bc2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002210
2211 If you do not have i2c muxes on your board, omit this define.
2212
Heiko Schocher479a4cf2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002213- Legacy I2C Support: CONFIG_HARD_I2C
Heiko Schochere0e55bc2012-01-16 21:12:24 +00002214
2215 NOTE: It is intended to move drivers to CONFIG_SYS_I2C which
2216 provides the following compelling advantages:
2217
2218 - more than one i2c adapter is usable
2219 - approved multibus support
2220 - better i2c mux support
2221
2222 ** Please consider updating your I2C driver now. **
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002223
Heiko Schocher479a4cf2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002224 These enable legacy I2C serial bus commands. Defining
2225 CONFIG_HARD_I2C will include the appropriate I2C driver
2226 for the selected CPU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002227
wdenk21136db2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002228 This will allow you to use i2c commands at the u-boot
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -05002229 command line (as long as you set CONFIG_CMD_I2C in
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002230 CONFIG_COMMANDS) and communicate with i2c based realtime
2231 clock chips. See common/cmd_i2c.c for a description of the
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002232 command line interface.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002233
Ben Warren45657152006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002234 CONFIG_HARD_I2C selects a hardware I2C controller.
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002235
wdenk21136db2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002236 There are several other quantities that must also be
Heiko Schocher479a4cf2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002237 defined when you define CONFIG_HARD_I2C.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002238
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002239 In both cases you will need to define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SPEED
wdenk21136db2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002240 to be the frequency (in Hz) at which you wish your i2c bus
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002241 to run and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to be the address of this node (ie
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002242 the CPU's i2c node address).
wdenk21136db2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002243
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -05002244 Now, the u-boot i2c code for the mpc8xx
Stefan Roese88fbf932010-04-15 16:07:28 +02002245 (arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8xx/i2c.c) sets the CPU up as a master node
Peter Tysere4d1abc2010-04-12 22:28:21 -05002246 and so its address should therefore be cleared to 0 (See,
2247 eg, MPC823e User's Manual p.16-473). So, set
2248 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002249
Eric Millbrandt12990a42009-09-03 08:09:44 -05002250 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_MPC5XXX
2251
2252 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
2253 chips might think that the current transfer is still
2254 in progress. Reset the slave devices by sending start
2255 commands until the slave device responds.
2256
wdenk21136db2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002257 That's all that's required for CONFIG_HARD_I2C.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002258
Heiko Schocher479a4cf2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01002259 If you use the software i2c interface (CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SOFT)
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002260 then the following macros need to be defined (examples are
2261 from include/configs/lwmon.h):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002262
2263 I2C_INIT
2264
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002265 (Optional). Any commands necessary to enable the I2C
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002266 controller or configure ports.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002267
wdenk544e9732004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002268 eg: #define I2C_INIT (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SCL)
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002269
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002270 I2C_PORT
2271
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002272 (Only for MPC8260 CPU). The I/O port to use (the code
2273 assumes both bits are on the same port). Valid values
2274 are 0..3 for ports A..D.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002275
2276 I2C_ACTIVE
2277
2278 The code necessary to make the I2C data line active
2279 (driven). If the data line is open collector, this
2280 define can be null.
2281
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002282 eg: #define I2C_ACTIVE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SDA)
2283
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002284 I2C_TRISTATE
2285
2286 The code necessary to make the I2C data line tri-stated
2287 (inactive). If the data line is open collector, this
2288 define can be null.
2289
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002290 eg: #define I2C_TRISTATE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir &= ~PB_SDA)
2291
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002292 I2C_READ
2293
York Sun4a598092013-04-01 11:29:11 -07002294 Code that returns true if the I2C data line is high,
2295 false if it is low.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002296
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002297 eg: #define I2C_READ ((immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat & PB_SDA) != 0)
2298
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002299 I2C_SDA(bit)
2300
York Sun4a598092013-04-01 11:29:11 -07002301 If <bit> is true, sets the I2C data line high. If it
2302 is false, it clears it (low).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002303
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002304 eg: #define I2C_SDA(bit) \
wdenk2bb11052003-07-17 23:16:40 +00002305 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SDA; \
wdenk544e9732004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002306 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SDA
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002307
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002308 I2C_SCL(bit)
2309
York Sun4a598092013-04-01 11:29:11 -07002310 If <bit> is true, sets the I2C clock line high. If it
2311 is false, it clears it (low).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002312
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002313 eg: #define I2C_SCL(bit) \
wdenk2bb11052003-07-17 23:16:40 +00002314 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SCL; \
wdenk544e9732004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002315 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SCL
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002316
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002317 I2C_DELAY
2318
2319 This delay is invoked four times per clock cycle so this
2320 controls the rate of data transfer. The data rate thus
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002321 is 1 / (I2C_DELAY * 4). Often defined to be something
wdenk21136db2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00002322 like:
2323
wdenkb9bbd242003-06-30 16:24:52 +00002324 #define I2C_DELAY udelay(2)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002325
Mike Frysingeree12d542010-07-21 13:38:02 -04002326 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SCL / CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SDA
2327
2328 If your arch supports the generic GPIO framework (asm/gpio.h),
2329 then you may alternatively define the two GPIOs that are to be
2330 used as SCL / SDA. Any of the previous I2C_xxx macros will
2331 have GPIO-based defaults assigned to them as appropriate.
2332
2333 You should define these to the GPIO value as given directly to
2334 the generic GPIO functions.
2335
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002336 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD
wdenkcc1e2562003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002337
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002338 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
2339 chips might think that the current transfer is still
2340 in progress. On some boards it is possible to access
2341 the i2c SCLK line directly, either by using the
2342 processor pin as a GPIO or by having a second pin
2343 connected to the bus. If this option is defined a
2344 custom i2c_init_board() routine in boards/xxx/board.c
2345 is run early in the boot sequence.
wdenkcc1e2562003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002346
Richard Retanubundf0149c2010-04-12 15:08:17 -04002347 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BOARD_LATE_INIT
2348
2349 An alternative to CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD. If this option is
2350 defined a custom i2c_board_late_init() routine in
2351 boards/xxx/board.c is run AFTER the operations in i2c_init()
2352 is completed. This callpoint can be used to unreset i2c bus
2353 using CPU i2c controller register accesses for CPUs whose i2c
2354 controller provide such a method. It is called at the end of
2355 i2c_init() to allow i2c_init operations to setup the i2c bus
2356 controller on the CPU (e.g. setting bus speed & slave address).
2357
wdenk0e2bd9c2004-06-06 21:51:03 +00002358 CONFIG_I2CFAST (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
2359
2360 This option enables configuration of bi_iic_fast[] flags
2361 in u-boot bd_info structure based on u-boot environment
2362 variable "i2cfast". (see also i2cfast)
2363
Ben Warren45657152006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002364 CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
2365
2366 This option allows the use of multiple I2C buses, each of which
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002367 must have a controller. At any point in time, only one bus is
2368 active. To switch to a different bus, use the 'i2c dev' command.
Ben Warren45657152006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002369 Note that bus numbering is zero-based.
2370
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002371 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES
Ben Warren45657152006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002372
2373 This option specifies a list of I2C devices that will be skipped
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002374 when the 'i2c probe' command is issued. If CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Peter Tyser469cde42009-04-18 22:34:03 -05002375 is set, specify a list of bus-device pairs. Otherwise, specify
2376 a 1D array of device addresses
Ben Warren45657152006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002377
2378 e.g.
2379 #undef CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002380 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES {0x50,0x68}
Ben Warren45657152006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002381
2382 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on a board with one I2C bus
2383
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002384 #define CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002385 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MULTI_NOPROBES {{0,0x50},{0,0x68},{1,0x54}}
Ben Warren45657152006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002386
2387 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on bus 0 and address 0x54 on bus 1
2388
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002389 CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Timur Tabiab347542006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002390
2391 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for DDR SPD.
2392 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that SPD is on I2C bus 0.
2393
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002394 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese096cc9b2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01002395
2396 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the RTC.
2397 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that RTC is on I2C bus 0.
2398
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002399 CONFIG_SYS_DTT_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese096cc9b2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01002400
2401 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the DTT.
2402 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that DTT is on I2C bus 0.
2403
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002404 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DTT_ADDR:
Victor Gallardo31856dd2008-09-09 15:13:29 -07002405
2406 If defined, specifies the I2C address of the DTT device.
2407 If not defined, then U-Boot uses predefined value for
2408 specified DTT device.
2409
Andrew Dyer58c41f92008-12-29 17:36:01 -06002410 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_READ_REPEATED_START
2411
2412 defining this will force the i2c_read() function in
2413 the soft_i2c driver to perform an I2C repeated start
2414 between writing the address pointer and reading the
2415 data. If this define is omitted the default behaviour
2416 of doing a stop-start sequence will be used. Most I2C
2417 devices can use either method, but some require one or
2418 the other.
Timur Tabiab347542006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002419
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002420- SPI Support: CONFIG_SPI
2421
2422 Enables SPI driver (so far only tested with
2423 SPI EEPROM, also an instance works with Crystal A/D and
2424 D/As on the SACSng board)
2425
Yoshihiro Shimoda65bd9b42011-01-31 16:50:43 +09002426 CONFIG_SH_SPI
2427
2428 Enables the driver for SPI controller on SuperH. Currently
2429 only SH7757 is supported.
2430
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002431 CONFIG_SPI_X
2432
2433 Enables extended (16-bit) SPI EEPROM addressing.
2434 (symmetrical to CONFIG_I2C_X)
2435
2436 CONFIG_SOFT_SPI
2437
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002438 Enables a software (bit-bang) SPI driver rather than
2439 using hardware support. This is a general purpose
2440 driver that only requires three general I/O port pins
2441 (two outputs, one input) to function. If this is
2442 defined, the board configuration must define several
2443 SPI configuration items (port pins to use, etc). For
2444 an example, see include/configs/sacsng.h.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002445
Ben Warren7efe9272008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002446 CONFIG_HARD_SPI
2447
2448 Enables a hardware SPI driver for general-purpose reads
2449 and writes. As with CONFIG_SOFT_SPI, the board configuration
2450 must define a list of chip-select function pointers.
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002451 Currently supported on some MPC8xxx processors. For an
Ben Warren7efe9272008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002452 example, see include/configs/mpc8349emds.h.
2453
Guennadi Liakhovetski07327a52008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002454 CONFIG_MXC_SPI
2455
2456 Enables the driver for the SPI controllers on i.MX and MXC
Fabio Estevamdcd342c2011-10-28 08:57:46 +00002457 SoCs. Currently i.MX31/35/51 are supported.
Guennadi Liakhovetski07327a52008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002458
Matthias Fuchsa4400872007-12-27 17:12:34 +01002459- FPGA Support: CONFIG_FPGA
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002460
Matthias Fuchsa4400872007-12-27 17:12:34 +01002461 Enables FPGA subsystem.
2462
2463 CONFIG_FPGA_<vendor>
2464
2465 Enables support for specific chip vendors.
2466 (ALTERA, XILINX)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002467
Matthias Fuchsa4400872007-12-27 17:12:34 +01002468 CONFIG_FPGA_<family>
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002469
Matthias Fuchsa4400872007-12-27 17:12:34 +01002470 Enables support for FPGA family.
2471 (SPARTAN2, SPARTAN3, VIRTEX2, CYCLONE2, ACEX1K, ACEX)
2472
2473 CONFIG_FPGA_COUNT
2474
2475 Specify the number of FPGA devices to support.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002476
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002477 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_PROG_FEEDBACK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002478
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002479 Enable printing of hash marks during FPGA configuration.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002480
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002481 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002482
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002483 Enable checks on FPGA configuration interface busy
2484 status by the configuration function. This option
2485 will require a board or device specific function to
2486 be written.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002487
2488 CONFIG_FPGA_DELAY
2489
2490 If defined, a function that provides delays in the FPGA
2491 configuration driver.
2492
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002493 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_CTRLC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002494 Allow Control-C to interrupt FPGA configuration
2495
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002496 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_ERROR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002497
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002498 Check for configuration errors during FPGA bitfile
2499 loading. For example, abort during Virtex II
2500 configuration if the INIT_B line goes low (which
2501 indicated a CRC error).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002502
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002503 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_INIT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002504
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002505 Maximum time to wait for the INIT_B line to deassert
2506 after PROB_B has been deasserted during a Virtex II
2507 FPGA configuration sequence. The default time is 500
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002508 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002509
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002510 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002511
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002512 Maximum time to wait for BUSY to deassert during
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002513 Virtex II FPGA configuration. The default is 5 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002514
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002515 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_CONFIG
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002516
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002517 Time to wait after FPGA configuration. The default is
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002518 200 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002519
2520- Configuration Management:
2521 CONFIG_IDENT_STRING
2522
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002523 If defined, this string will be added to the U-Boot
2524 version information (U_BOOT_VERSION)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002525
2526- Vendor Parameter Protection:
2527
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002528 U-Boot considers the values of the environment
2529 variables "serial#" (Board Serial Number) and
wdenkeb20ad32003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002530 "ethaddr" (Ethernet Address) to be parameters that
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002531 are set once by the board vendor / manufacturer, and
2532 protects these variables from casual modification by
2533 the user. Once set, these variables are read-only,
2534 and write or delete attempts are rejected. You can
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002535 change this behaviour:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002536
2537 If CONFIG_ENV_OVERWRITE is #defined in your config
2538 file, the write protection for vendor parameters is
wdenkcc1e2562003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002539 completely disabled. Anybody can change or delete
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002540 these parameters.
2541
2542 Alternatively, if you #define _both_ CONFIG_ETHADDR
2543 _and_ CONFIG_OVERWRITE_ETHADDR_ONCE, a default
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002544 Ethernet address is installed in the environment,
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002545 which can be changed exactly ONCE by the user. [The
2546 serial# is unaffected by this, i. e. it remains
2547 read-only.]
2548
Joe Hershberger71497d02012-12-11 22:16:31 -06002549 The same can be accomplished in a more flexible way
2550 for any variable by configuring the type of access
2551 to allow for those variables in the ".flags" variable
2552 or define CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC.
2553
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002554- Protected RAM:
2555 CONFIG_PRAM
2556
2557 Define this variable to enable the reservation of
2558 "protected RAM", i. e. RAM which is not overwritten
2559 by U-Boot. Define CONFIG_PRAM to hold the number of
2560 kB you want to reserve for pRAM. You can overwrite
2561 this default value by defining an environment
2562 variable "pram" to the number of kB you want to
2563 reserve. Note that the board info structure will
2564 still show the full amount of RAM. If pRAM is
2565 reserved, a new environment variable "mem" will
2566 automatically be defined to hold the amount of
2567 remaining RAM in a form that can be passed as boot
2568 argument to Linux, for instance like that:
2569
Wolfgang Denk86eb3b72005-11-20 21:40:11 +01002570 setenv bootargs ... mem=\${mem}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002571 saveenv
2572
2573 This way you can tell Linux not to use this memory,
2574 either, which results in a memory region that will
2575 not be affected by reboots.
2576
2577 *WARNING* If your board configuration uses automatic
2578 detection of the RAM size, you must make sure that
2579 this memory test is non-destructive. So far, the
2580 following board configurations are known to be
2581 "pRAM-clean":
2582
Wolfgang Denk90326762012-10-24 02:36:15 +00002583 IVMS8, IVML24, SPD8xx, TQM8xxL,
2584 HERMES, IP860, RPXlite, LWMON,
Wolfgang Denkcd4e42e2010-10-05 22:54:53 +02002585 FLAGADM, TQM8260
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002586
Gabe Blacka2f3a932012-12-02 04:55:18 +00002587- Access to physical memory region (> 4GB)
2588 Some basic support is provided for operations on memory not
2589 normally accessible to U-Boot - e.g. some architectures
2590 support access to more than 4GB of memory on 32-bit
2591 machines using physical address extension or similar.
2592 Define CONFIG_PHYSMEM to access this basic support, which
2593 currently only supports clearing the memory.
2594
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002595- Error Recovery:
2596 CONFIG_PANIC_HANG
2597
2598 Define this variable to stop the system in case of a
2599 fatal error, so that you have to reset it manually.
2600 This is probably NOT a good idea for an embedded
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002601 system where you want the system to reboot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002602 automatically as fast as possible, but it may be
2603 useful during development since you can try to debug
2604 the conditions that lead to the situation.
2605
2606 CONFIG_NET_RETRY_COUNT
2607
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002608 This variable defines the number of retries for
2609 network operations like ARP, RARP, TFTP, or BOOTP
2610 before giving up the operation. If not defined, a
2611 default value of 5 is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002612
Guennadi Liakhovetskib38c2b32008-04-03 17:04:19 +02002613 CONFIG_ARP_TIMEOUT
2614
2615 Timeout waiting for an ARP reply in milliseconds.
2616
Tetsuyuki Kobayashi147e3902012-07-03 22:25:21 +00002617 CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT
2618
2619 Timeout in milliseconds used in NFS protocol.
2620 If you encounter "ERROR: Cannot umount" in nfs command,
2621 try longer timeout such as
2622 #define CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT 10000UL
2623
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002624- Command Interpreter:
Wolfgang Denk81352ed2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002625 CONFIG_AUTO_COMPLETE
wdenk3902d702004-04-15 18:22:41 +00002626
2627 Enable auto completion of commands using TAB.
2628
Wolfgang Denk018147d2006-11-27 15:32:42 +01002629 Note that this feature has NOT been implemented yet
2630 for the "hush" shell.
Wolfgang Denk81352ed2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002631
2632
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002633 CONFIG_SYS_HUSH_PARSER
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002634
2635 Define this variable to enable the "hush" shell (from
2636 Busybox) as command line interpreter, thus enabling
2637 powerful command line syntax like
2638 if...then...else...fi conditionals or `&&' and '||'
2639 constructs ("shell scripts").
2640
2641 If undefined, you get the old, much simpler behaviour
2642 with a somewhat smaller memory footprint.
2643
2644
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002645 CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT_HUSH_PS2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002646
2647 This defines the secondary prompt string, which is
2648 printed when the command interpreter needs more input
2649 to complete a command. Usually "> ".
2650
2651 Note:
2652
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002653 In the current implementation, the local variables
2654 space and global environment variables space are
2655 separated. Local variables are those you define by
2656 simply typing `name=value'. To access a local
2657 variable later on, you have write `$name' or
2658 `${name}'; to execute the contents of a variable
2659 directly type `$name' at the command prompt.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002660
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002661 Global environment variables are those you use
2662 setenv/printenv to work with. To run a command stored
2663 in such a variable, you need to use the run command,
2664 and you must not use the '$' sign to access them.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002665
2666 To store commands and special characters in a
2667 variable, please use double quotation marks
2668 surrounding the whole text of the variable, instead
2669 of the backslashes before semicolons and special
2670 symbols.
2671
Wolfgang Denk2039a072006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002672- Commandline Editing and History:
2673 CONFIG_CMDLINE_EDITING
2674
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002675 Enable editing and History functions for interactive
Wolfgang Denkc80857e2006-07-21 11:56:05 +02002676 commandline input operations
Wolfgang Denk2039a072006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002677
wdenkc0aa5c52003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002678- Default Environment:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002679 CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS
2680
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002681 Define this to contain any number of null terminated
2682 strings (variable = value pairs) that will be part of
wdenkeb20ad32003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002683 the default environment compiled into the boot image.
wdenk591dda52002-11-18 00:14:45 +00002684
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002685 For example, place something like this in your
2686 board's config file:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002687
2688 #define CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS \
2689 "myvar1=value1\0" \
2690 "myvar2=value2\0"
2691
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002692 Warning: This method is based on knowledge about the
2693 internal format how the environment is stored by the
2694 U-Boot code. This is NOT an official, exported
2695 interface! Although it is unlikely that this format
wdenkeb20ad32003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002696 will change soon, there is no guarantee either.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002697 You better know what you are doing here.
2698
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002699 Note: overly (ab)use of the default environment is
2700 discouraged. Make sure to check other ways to preset
Wolfgang Denk85c25df2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002701 the environment like the "source" command or the
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002702 boot command first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002703
Stephen Warren1465d5f2012-05-22 09:21:54 +00002704 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_CONFIG
2705
2706 Define this in order to add variables describing the
2707 U-Boot build configuration to the default environment.
2708 These will be named arch, cpu, board, vendor, and soc.
2709
2710 Enabling this option will cause the following to be defined:
2711
2712 - CONFIG_SYS_ARCH
2713 - CONFIG_SYS_CPU
2714 - CONFIG_SYS_BOARD
2715 - CONFIG_SYS_VENDOR
2716 - CONFIG_SYS_SOC
2717
Tom Rini4c8cc9b2012-10-24 07:28:16 +00002718 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_RUNTIME_CONFIG
2719
2720 Define this in order to add variables describing certain
2721 run-time determined information about the hardware to the
2722 environment. These will be named board_name, board_rev.
2723
Simon Glass6b8d5fd2012-11-30 13:01:17 +00002724 CONFIG_DELAY_ENVIRONMENT
2725
2726 Normally the environment is loaded when the board is
2727 intialised so that it is available to U-Boot. This inhibits
2728 that so that the environment is not available until
2729 explicitly loaded later by U-Boot code. With CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
2730 this is instead controlled by the value of
2731 /config/load-environment.
2732
wdenkc0aa5c52003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002733- DataFlash Support:
wdenk381669a2003-06-16 23:50:08 +00002734 CONFIG_HAS_DATAFLASH
2735
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002736 Defining this option enables DataFlash features and
2737 allows to read/write in Dataflash via the standard
2738 commands cp, md...
wdenk381669a2003-06-16 23:50:08 +00002739
Eric Nelson97f5f8f2012-01-31 10:52:08 -07002740- Serial Flash support
2741 CONFIG_CMD_SF
2742
2743 Defining this option enables SPI flash commands
2744 'sf probe/read/write/erase/update'.
2745
2746 Usage requires an initial 'probe' to define the serial
2747 flash parameters, followed by read/write/erase/update
2748 commands.
2749
2750 The following defaults may be provided by the platform
2751 to handle the common case when only a single serial
2752 flash is present on the system.
2753
2754 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_BUS Bus identifier
2755 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_CS Chip-select
2756 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_MODE (see include/spi.h)
2757 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_SPEED in Hz
2758
Simon Glass4b5545e2012-10-08 13:16:02 +00002759 CONFIG_CMD_SF_TEST
2760
2761 Define this option to include a destructive SPI flash
2762 test ('sf test').
2763
Jagannadha Sutradharudu Tekic6d173d2013-06-19 15:33:58 +05302764 CONFIG_SPI_FLASH_BAR Ban/Extended Addr Reg
2765
2766 Define this option to use the Bank addr/Extended addr
2767 support on SPI flashes which has size > 16Mbytes.
2768
Jagannadha Sutradharudu Tekid7f253b2014-01-11 15:25:04 +05302769 CONFIG_SF_DUAL_FLASH Dual flash memories
2770
2771 Define this option to use dual flash support where two flash
2772 memories can be connected with a given cs line.
2773 currently Xilinx Zynq qspi support these type of connections.
2774
wdenkef893942004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002775- SystemACE Support:
2776 CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
2777
2778 Adding this option adds support for Xilinx SystemACE
2779 chips attached via some sort of local bus. The address
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002780 of the chip must also be defined in the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002781 CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE macro. For example:
wdenkef893942004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002782
2783 #define CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002784 #define CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE 0xf0000000
wdenkef893942004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002785
2786 When SystemACE support is added, the "ace" device type
2787 becomes available to the fat commands, i.e. fatls.
2788
Wolfgang Denke3cfce52005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002789- TFTP Fixed UDP Port:
2790 CONFIG_TFTP_PORT
2791
Wolfgang Denk227b5192005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002792 If this is defined, the environment variable tftpsrcp
Wolfgang Denke3cfce52005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002793 is used to supply the TFTP UDP source port value.
Wolfgang Denk227b5192005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002794 If tftpsrcp isn't defined, the normal pseudo-random port
Wolfgang Denke3cfce52005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002795 number generator is used.
2796
Wolfgang Denk227b5192005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002797 Also, the environment variable tftpdstp is used to supply
2798 the TFTP UDP destination port value. If tftpdstp isn't
2799 defined, the normal port 69 is used.
2800
2801 The purpose for tftpsrcp is to allow a TFTP server to
Wolfgang Denke3cfce52005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002802 blindly start the TFTP transfer using the pre-configured
2803 target IP address and UDP port. This has the effect of
2804 "punching through" the (Windows XP) firewall, allowing
2805 the remainder of the TFTP transfer to proceed normally.
2806 A better solution is to properly configure the firewall,
2807 but sometimes that is not allowed.
2808
Simon Glass058bb8d2012-12-05 14:46:38 +00002809- Hashing support:
2810 CONFIG_CMD_HASH
2811
2812 This enables a generic 'hash' command which can produce
2813 hashes / digests from a few algorithms (e.g. SHA1, SHA256).
2814
2815 CONFIG_HASH_VERIFY
2816
2817 Enable the hash verify command (hash -v). This adds to code
2818 size a little.
2819
2820 CONFIG_SHA1 - support SHA1 hashing
2821 CONFIG_SHA256 - support SHA256 hashing
2822
2823 Note: There is also a sha1sum command, which should perhaps
2824 be deprecated in favour of 'hash sha1'.
2825
Robert Winkler765ccf42013-07-24 17:57:06 -07002826- Freescale i.MX specific commands:
2827 CONFIG_CMD_HDMIDETECT
2828 This enables 'hdmidet' command which returns true if an
2829 HDMI monitor is detected. This command is i.MX 6 specific.
2830
2831 CONFIG_CMD_BMODE
2832 This enables the 'bmode' (bootmode) command for forcing
2833 a boot from specific media.
2834
2835 This is useful for forcing the ROM's usb downloader to
2836 activate upon a watchdog reset which is nice when iterating
2837 on U-Boot. Using the reset button or running bmode normal
2838 will set it back to normal. This command currently
2839 supports i.MX53 and i.MX6.
2840
Simon Glass35191a32013-06-13 15:10:02 -07002841- Signing support:
2842 CONFIG_RSA
2843
2844 This enables the RSA algorithm used for FIT image verification
2845 in U-Boot. See doc/uImage/signature for more information.
2846
2847 The signing part is build into mkimage regardless of this
2848 option.
2849
2850
wdenkc0aa5c52003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002851- Show boot progress:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002852 CONFIG_SHOW_BOOT_PROGRESS
2853
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002854 Defining this option allows to add some board-
2855 specific code (calling a user-provided function
2856 "show_boot_progress(int)") that enables you to show
2857 the system's boot progress on some display (for
2858 example, some LED's) on your board. At the moment,
2859 the following checkpoints are implemented:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002860
Simon Glass31a870e2012-02-13 13:51:19 +00002861- Detailed boot stage timing
2862 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE
2863 Define this option to get detailed timing of each stage
2864 of the boot process.
2865
2866 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_USER_COUNT
2867 This is the number of available user bootstage records.
2868 Each time you call bootstage_mark(BOOTSTAGE_ID_ALLOC, ...)
2869 a new ID will be allocated from this stash. If you exceed
2870 the limit, recording will stop.
2871
2872 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_REPORT
2873 Define this to print a report before boot, similar to this:
2874
2875 Timer summary in microseconds:
2876 Mark Elapsed Stage
2877 0 0 reset
2878 3,575,678 3,575,678 board_init_f start
2879 3,575,695 17 arch_cpu_init A9
2880 3,575,777 82 arch_cpu_init done
2881 3,659,598 83,821 board_init_r start
2882 3,910,375 250,777 main_loop
2883 29,916,167 26,005,792 bootm_start
2884 30,361,327 445,160 start_kernel
2885
Simon Glass4afd88e2012-09-28 08:56:39 +00002886 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTSTAGE
2887 Add a 'bootstage' command which supports printing a report
2888 and un/stashing of bootstage data.
2889
Simon Glass0fa36a42012-09-28 08:56:37 +00002890 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_FDT
2891 Stash the bootstage information in the FDT. A root 'bootstage'
2892 node is created with each bootstage id as a child. Each child
2893 has a 'name' property and either 'mark' containing the
2894 mark time in microsecond, or 'accum' containing the
2895 accumulated time for that bootstage id in microseconds.
2896 For example:
2897
2898 bootstage {
2899 154 {
2900 name = "board_init_f";
2901 mark = <3575678>;
2902 };
2903 170 {
2904 name = "lcd";
2905 accum = <33482>;
2906 };
2907 };
2908
2909 Code in the Linux kernel can find this in /proc/devicetree.
2910
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002911Legacy uImage format:
2912
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002913 Arg Where When
2914 1 common/cmd_bootm.c before attempting to boot an image
wdenk544e9732004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002915 -1 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad magic number
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002916 2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct magic number
wdenk544e9732004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002917 -2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002918 3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct checksum
wdenk544e9732004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002919 -3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002920 4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has correct checksum
2921 -4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image is for unsupported architecture
2922 5 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002923 -5 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong Image Type (not kernel, multi)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002924 6 common/cmd_bootm.c Image Type check OK
2925 -6 common/cmd_bootm.c gunzip uncompression error
2926 -7 common/cmd_bootm.c Unimplemented compression type
2927 7 common/cmd_bootm.c Uncompression OK
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002928 8 common/cmd_bootm.c No uncompress/copy overwrite error
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002929 -9 common/cmd_bootm.c Unsupported OS (not Linux, BSD, VxWorks, QNX)
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002930
2931 9 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
2932 -10 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad magic number
2933 -11 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad checksum
2934 10 common/image.c Ramdisk header is OK
2935 -12 common/image.c Ramdisk data has bad checksum
2936 11 common/image.c Ramdisk data has correct checksum
2937 12 common/image.c Ramdisk verification complete, start loading
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002938 -13 common/image.c Wrong Image Type (not PPC Linux ramdisk)
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002939 13 common/image.c Start multifile image verification
2940 14 common/image.c No initial ramdisk, no multifile, continue.
2941
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002942 15 arch/<arch>/lib/bootm.c All preparation done, transferring control to OS
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002943
Stefan Roese88fbf932010-04-15 16:07:28 +02002944 -30 arch/powerpc/lib/board.c Fatal error, hang the system
wdenkd729d302004-02-27 00:07:27 +00002945 -31 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_output_backlog()
2946 -32 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_run_single()
wdenke97d3d92004-02-23 22:22:28 +00002947
Heiko Schocher633e03a2007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002948 34 common/cmd_doc.c before loading a Image from a DOC device
2949 -35 common/cmd_doc.c Bad usage of "doc" command
2950 35 common/cmd_doc.c correct usage of "doc" command
2951 -36 common/cmd_doc.c No boot device
2952 36 common/cmd_doc.c correct boot device
2953 -37 common/cmd_doc.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
2954 37 common/cmd_doc.c correct chip ID found, device available
2955 -38 common/cmd_doc.c Read Error on boot device
2956 38 common/cmd_doc.c reading Image header from DOC device OK
2957 -39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has bad magic number
2958 39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
2959 -40 common/cmd_doc.c Error reading Image from DOC device
2960 40 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
2961 41 common/cmd_ide.c before loading a Image from a IDE device
2962 -42 common/cmd_ide.c Bad usage of "ide" command
2963 42 common/cmd_ide.c correct usage of "ide" command
2964 -43 common/cmd_ide.c No boot device
2965 43 common/cmd_ide.c boot device found
2966 -44 common/cmd_ide.c Device not available
2967 44 common/cmd_ide.c Device available
2968 -45 common/cmd_ide.c wrong partition selected
2969 45 common/cmd_ide.c partition selected
2970 -46 common/cmd_ide.c Unknown partition table
2971 46 common/cmd_ide.c valid partition table found
2972 -47 common/cmd_ide.c Invalid partition type
2973 47 common/cmd_ide.c correct partition type
2974 -48 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
2975 48 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image Header from IDE device OK
2976 -49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad magic number
2977 49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct magic number
2978 -50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad checksum
2979 50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct checksum
2980 -51 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image from IDE device
2981 51 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image from IDE device OK
2982 52 common/cmd_nand.c before loading a Image from a NAND device
2983 -53 common/cmd_nand.c Bad usage of "nand" command
2984 53 common/cmd_nand.c correct usage of "nand" command
2985 -54 common/cmd_nand.c No boot device
2986 54 common/cmd_nand.c boot device found
2987 -55 common/cmd_nand.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
2988 55 common/cmd_nand.c correct chip ID found, device available
2989 -56 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
2990 56 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image Header from NAND device OK
2991 -57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has bad magic number
2992 57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has correct magic number
2993 -58 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image from NAND device
2994 58 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image from NAND device OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002995
Heiko Schocher633e03a2007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002996 -60 common/env_common.c Environment has a bad CRC, using default
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002997
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002998 64 net/eth.c starting with Ethernet configuration.
Heiko Schocher633e03a2007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002999 -64 net/eth.c no Ethernet found.
3000 65 net/eth.c Ethernet found.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003001
Heiko Schocher633e03a2007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003002 -80 common/cmd_net.c usage wrong
3003 80 common/cmd_net.c before calling NetLoop()
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003004 -81 common/cmd_net.c some error in NetLoop() occurred
Heiko Schocher633e03a2007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003005 81 common/cmd_net.c NetLoop() back without error
3006 -82 common/cmd_net.c size == 0 (File with size 0 loaded)
3007 82 common/cmd_net.c trying automatic boot
Wolfgang Denk85c25df2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02003008 83 common/cmd_net.c running "source" command
3009 -83 common/cmd_net.c some error in automatic boot or "source" command
Heiko Schocher633e03a2007-06-22 19:11:54 +02003010 84 common/cmd_net.c end without errors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003011
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003012FIT uImage format:
3013
3014 Arg Where When
3015 100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has correct format
3016 -100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has incorrect format
3017 101 common/cmd_bootm.c No Kernel subimage unit name, using configuration
3018 -101 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get configuration for kernel subimage
3019 102 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel unit name specified
3020 -103 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage node offset
Marian Balakowicz0cd4f3d2008-03-12 10:35:46 +01003021 103 common/cmd_bootm.c Found configuration node
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003022 104 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage node offset
3023 -104 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification failed
3024 105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification OK
3025 -105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage is for unsupported architecture
3026 106 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003027 -106 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage has wrong type
3028 107 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage type OK
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003029 -107 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage data/size
3030 108 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage data/size
3031 -108 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong image type (not legacy, FIT)
3032 -109 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage type
3033 -110 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage comp
3034 -111 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage os
3035 -112 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage load address
3036 -113 common/cmd_bootm.c Image uncompress/copy overwrite error
3037
3038 120 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
3039 -120 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has incorrect format
3040 121 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has correct format
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003041 122 common/image.c No ramdisk subimage unit name, using configuration
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003042 -122 common/image.c Can't get configuration for ramdisk subimage
3043 123 common/image.c Ramdisk unit name specified
3044 -124 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage node offset
3045 125 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage node offset
3046 -125 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification failed
3047 126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification OK
3048 -126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage for unsupported architecture
3049 127 common/image.c Architecture check OK
3050 -127 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage data/size
3051 128 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage data/size
3052 129 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk load address
3053 -129 common/image.c Got ramdisk load address
3054
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003055 -130 common/cmd_doc.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003056 131 common/cmd_doc.c FIT image format OK
3057
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003058 -140 common/cmd_ide.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003059 141 common/cmd_ide.c FIT image format OK
3060
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003061 -150 common/cmd_nand.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003062 151 common/cmd_nand.c FIT image format OK
3063
Gabe Blackd572e162012-10-25 16:31:10 +00003064- FIT image support:
3065 CONFIG_FIT
3066 Enable support for the FIT uImage format.
3067
3068 CONFIG_FIT_BEST_MATCH
3069 When no configuration is explicitly selected, default to the
3070 one whose fdt's compatibility field best matches that of
3071 U-Boot itself. A match is considered "best" if it matches the
3072 most specific compatibility entry of U-Boot's fdt's root node.
3073 The order of entries in the configuration's fdt is ignored.
3074
Simon Glass58fe7e52013-06-13 15:10:00 -07003075 CONFIG_FIT_SIGNATURE
3076 This option enables signature verification of FIT uImages,
3077 using a hash signed and verified using RSA. See
3078 doc/uImage.FIT/signature.txt for more details.
3079
Wolfgang Denkd590fb12011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003080- Standalone program support:
3081 CONFIG_STANDALONE_LOAD_ADDR
3082
Wolfgang Denk23f78482011-10-09 21:06:34 +02003083 This option defines a board specific value for the
3084 address where standalone program gets loaded, thus
3085 overwriting the architecture dependent default
Wolfgang Denkd590fb12011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003086 settings.
3087
3088- Frame Buffer Address:
3089 CONFIG_FB_ADDR
3090
3091 Define CONFIG_FB_ADDR if you want to use specific
Wolfgang Denka71eb8e2013-01-03 00:43:59 +00003092 address for frame buffer. This is typically the case
3093 when using a graphics controller has separate video
3094 memory. U-Boot will then place the frame buffer at
3095 the given address instead of dynamically reserving it
3096 in system RAM by calling lcd_setmem(), which grabs
3097 the memory for the frame buffer depending on the
3098 configured panel size.
Wolfgang Denkd590fb12011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003099
3100 Please see board_init_f function.
3101
Detlev Zundel0ecb6112009-12-01 17:16:19 +01003102- Automatic software updates via TFTP server
3103 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP
3104 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_CNT_MAX
3105 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_MSEC_MAX
3106
3107 These options enable and control the auto-update feature;
3108 for a more detailed description refer to doc/README.update.
3109
3110- MTD Support (mtdparts command, UBI support)
3111 CONFIG_MTD_DEVICE
3112
3113 Adds the MTD device infrastructure from the Linux kernel.
3114 Needed for mtdparts command support.
3115
3116 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS
3117
3118 Adds the MTD partitioning infrastructure from the Linux
3119 kernel. Needed for UBI support.
3120
Joe Hershberger7d80fc12013-04-08 10:32:48 +00003121- UBI support
3122 CONFIG_CMD_UBI
3123
3124 Adds commands for interacting with MTD partitions formatted
3125 with the UBI flash translation layer
3126
3127 Requires also defining CONFIG_RBTREE
3128
Joe Hershberger47550fc2013-04-08 10:32:49 +00003129 CONFIG_UBI_SILENCE_MSG
3130
3131 Make the verbose messages from UBI stop printing. This leaves
3132 warnings and errors enabled.
3133
Joe Hershberger7d80fc12013-04-08 10:32:48 +00003134- UBIFS support
3135 CONFIG_CMD_UBIFS
3136
3137 Adds commands for interacting with UBI volumes formatted as
3138 UBIFS. UBIFS is read-only in u-boot.
3139
3140 Requires UBI support as well as CONFIG_LZO
3141
Joe Hershberger47550fc2013-04-08 10:32:49 +00003142 CONFIG_UBIFS_SILENCE_MSG
3143
3144 Make the verbose messages from UBIFS stop printing. This leaves
3145 warnings and errors enabled.
3146
Daniel Schwierzeck39ca08e2011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003147- SPL framework
Wolfgang Denk825223d2011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003148 CONFIG_SPL
3149 Enable building of SPL globally.
Daniel Schwierzeck39ca08e2011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003150
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003151 CONFIG_SPL_LDSCRIPT
3152 LDSCRIPT for linking the SPL binary.
3153
Albert ARIBAUDe916e052013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003154 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT
3155 Maximum size in memory allocated to the SPL, BSS included.
3156 When defined, the linker checks that the actual memory
3157 used by SPL from _start to __bss_end does not exceed it.
Albert ARIBAUDafab1482013-04-14 04:48:38 +00003158 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT and CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUDe916e052013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003159 must not be both defined at the same time.
3160
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003161 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUDe916e052013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003162 Maximum size of the SPL image (text, data, rodata, and
3163 linker lists sections), BSS excluded.
3164 When defined, the linker checks that the actual size does
3165 not exceed it.
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003166
Wolfgang Denk825223d2011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003167 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE
3168 TEXT_BASE for linking the SPL binary.
Daniel Schwierzeck39ca08e2011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003169
Scott Woodc4f0d002012-09-20 19:05:12 -05003170 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_TEXT_BASE
3171 Address to relocate to. If unspecified, this is equal to
3172 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE (i.e. no relocation is done).
3173
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003174 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_START_ADDR
3175 Link address for the BSS within the SPL binary.
3176
3177 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUDe916e052013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003178 Maximum size in memory allocated to the SPL BSS.
3179 When defined, the linker checks that the actual memory used
3180 by SPL from __bss_start to __bss_end does not exceed it.
Albert ARIBAUDafab1482013-04-14 04:48:38 +00003181 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_FOOTPRINT and CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
Albert ARIBAUDe916e052013-04-12 05:14:30 +00003182 must not be both defined at the same time.
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003183
3184 CONFIG_SPL_STACK
3185 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use
3186
Scott Woodc4f0d002012-09-20 19:05:12 -05003187 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_STACK
3188 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use after
3189 relocation. If unspecified, this is equal to
3190 CONFIG_SPL_STACK.
3191
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003192 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_START
3193 Starting address of the malloc pool used in SPL.
3194
3195 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_SIZE
3196 The size of the malloc pool used in SPL.
Daniel Schwierzeck39ca08e2011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003197
Tom Rini28591df2012-08-13 12:03:19 -07003198 CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK
3199 Enable the SPL framework under common/. This framework
3200 supports MMC, NAND and YMODEM loading of U-Boot and NAND
3201 NAND loading of the Linux Kernel.
3202
Tom Rinife3b0c72012-08-13 11:37:56 -07003203 CONFIG_SPL_DISPLAY_PRINT
3204 For ARM, enable an optional function to print more information
3205 about the running system.
3206
Scott Wood7c810902012-09-20 16:35:21 -05003207 CONFIG_SPL_INIT_MINIMAL
3208 Arch init code should be built for a very small image
3209
Wolfgang Denk825223d2011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003210 CONFIG_SPL_LIBCOMMON_SUPPORT
3211 Support for common/libcommon.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck39ca08e2011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003212
Wolfgang Denk825223d2011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003213 CONFIG_SPL_LIBDISK_SUPPORT
3214 Support for disk/libdisk.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck39ca08e2011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003215
Wolfgang Denk825223d2011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003216 CONFIG_SPL_I2C_SUPPORT
3217 Support for drivers/i2c/libi2c.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck39ca08e2011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003218
Wolfgang Denk825223d2011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003219 CONFIG_SPL_GPIO_SUPPORT
3220 Support for drivers/gpio/libgpio.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck39ca08e2011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003221
Wolfgang Denk825223d2011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003222 CONFIG_SPL_MMC_SUPPORT
3223 Support for drivers/mmc/libmmc.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck39ca08e2011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003224
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003225 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_U_BOOT_SECTOR,
3226 CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_MAX_SIZE_SECTORS,
3227 CONFIG_SYS_MMC_SD_FAT_BOOT_PARTITION
3228 Address, size and partition on the MMC to load U-Boot from
3229 when the MMC is being used in raw mode.
3230
Peter Korsgaard01b542f2013-05-13 08:36:29 +00003231 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_KERNEL_SECTOR
3232 Sector to load kernel uImage from when MMC is being
3233 used in raw mode (for Falcon mode)
3234
3235 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_ARGS_SECTOR,
3236 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_ARGS_SECTORS
3237 Sector and number of sectors to load kernel argument
3238 parameters from when MMC is being used in raw mode
3239 (for falcon mode)
3240
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003241 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_SUPPORT
3242 Support for fs/fat/libfat.o in SPL binary
3243
3244 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_LOAD_PAYLOAD_NAME
3245 Filename to read to load U-Boot when reading from FAT
3246
Peter Korsgaard465f1f82013-05-13 08:36:27 +00003247 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_LOAD_KERNEL_NAME
3248 Filename to read to load kernel uImage when reading
3249 from FAT (for Falcon mode)
3250
3251 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_LOAD_ARGS_NAME
3252 Filename to read to load kernel argument parameters
3253 when reading from FAT (for Falcon mode)
3254
Scott Wood2b36fbb2012-12-06 13:33:17 +00003255 CONFIG_SPL_MPC83XX_WAIT_FOR_NAND
3256 Set this for NAND SPL on PPC mpc83xx targets, so that
3257 start.S waits for the rest of the SPL to load before
3258 continuing (the hardware starts execution after just
3259 loading the first page rather than the full 4K).
3260
Scott Woodc352a0c2012-09-20 19:09:07 -05003261 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_BASE
3262 Include nand_base.c in the SPL. Requires
3263 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS.
3264
3265 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS
3266 SPL uses normal NAND drivers, not minimal drivers.
3267
3268 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_ECC
3269 Include standard software ECC in the SPL
3270
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003271 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_SIMPLE
Scott Wood36c440e2012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003272 Support for NAND boot using simple NAND drivers that
3273 expose the cmd_ctrl() interface.
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003274
Ying Zhang9ff70262013-08-16 15:16:11 +08003275 CONFIG_SPL_MPC8XXX_INIT_DDR_SUPPORT
3276 Set for the SPL on PPC mpc8xxx targets, support for
York Sunf0626592013-09-30 09:22:09 -07003277 drivers/ddr/fsl/libddr.o in SPL binary.
Ying Zhang9ff70262013-08-16 15:16:11 +08003278
Ying Zhangdfb2b152013-08-16 15:16:12 +08003279 CONFIG_SPL_COMMON_INIT_DDR
3280 Set for common ddr init with serial presence detect in
3281 SPL binary.
3282
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003283 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_5_ADDR_CYCLE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_COUNT,
3284 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_OOBSIZE,
3285 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BLOCK_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BAD_BLOCK_POS,
3286 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCPOS, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCSIZE,
3287 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCBYTES
3288 Defines the size and behavior of the NAND that SPL uses
Scott Wood36c440e2012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003289 to read U-Boot
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003290
Prabhakar Kushwahaafffcb02013-12-11 12:42:11 +05303291 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_BOOT
3292 Add support NAND boot
3293
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003294 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_OFFS
Scott Wood36c440e2012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003295 Location in NAND to read U-Boot from
3296
3297 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_DST
3298 Location in memory to load U-Boot to
3299
3300 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_SIZE
3301 Size of image to load
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003302
3303 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_START
Scott Wood36c440e2012-09-21 18:35:27 -05003304 Entry point in loaded image to jump to
Tom Rini36853852012-02-14 07:29:40 +00003305
3306 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_HW_ECC_OOBFIRST
3307 Define this if you need to first read the OOB and then the
3308 data. This is used for example on davinci plattforms.
3309
3310 CONFIG_SPL_OMAP3_ID_NAND
3311 Support for an OMAP3-specific set of functions to return the
3312 ID and MFR of the first attached NAND chip, if present.
3313
Wolfgang Denk825223d2011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003314 CONFIG_SPL_SERIAL_SUPPORT
3315 Support for drivers/serial/libserial.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck39ca08e2011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003316
Wolfgang Denk825223d2011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003317 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_FLASH_SUPPORT
3318 Support for drivers/mtd/spi/libspi_flash.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck39ca08e2011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003319
Wolfgang Denk825223d2011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003320 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_SUPPORT
3321 Support for drivers/spi/libspi.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck39ca08e2011-07-18 07:48:07 +00003322
Pavel Machekde997252012-08-30 22:42:11 +02003323 CONFIG_SPL_RAM_DEVICE
3324 Support for running image already present in ram, in SPL binary
3325
Wolfgang Denk825223d2011-09-11 21:24:09 +02003326 CONFIG_SPL_LIBGENERIC_SUPPORT
3327 Support for lib/libgeneric.o in SPL binary
Marian Balakowicz74eb4ae2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01003328
Ying Zhang602f7d32013-05-20 14:07:25 +08003329 CONFIG_SPL_ENV_SUPPORT
3330 Support for the environment operating in SPL binary
3331
3332 CONFIG_SPL_NET_SUPPORT
3333 Support for the net/libnet.o in SPL binary.
3334 It conflicts with SPL env from storage medium specified by
3335 CONFIG_ENV_IS_xxx but CONFIG_ENV_IS_NOWHERE
3336
Scott Woodeb7bd972012-12-06 13:33:16 +00003337 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO
Benoît Thébaudeauf0180722013-04-11 09:35:49 +00003338 Image offset to which the SPL should be padded before appending
3339 the SPL payload. By default, this is defined as
3340 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE, or 0 if CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE is undefined.
3341 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO must be either 0, meaning to append the SPL
3342 payload without any padding, or >= CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE.
Scott Woodeb7bd972012-12-06 13:33:16 +00003343
Scott Woodf147eb72012-09-21 16:27:32 -05003344 CONFIG_SPL_TARGET
3345 Final target image containing SPL and payload. Some SPLs
3346 use an arch-specific makefile fragment instead, for
3347 example if more than one image needs to be produced.
3348
Simon Glass82d94532013-05-08 08:05:59 +00003349 CONFIG_FIT_SPL_PRINT
3350 Printing information about a FIT image adds quite a bit of
3351 code to SPL. So this is normally disabled in SPL. Use this
3352 option to re-enable it. This will affect the output of the
3353 bootm command when booting a FIT image.
3354
Ying Zhang2d2e3b62013-08-16 15:16:15 +08003355- TPL framework
3356 CONFIG_TPL
3357 Enable building of TPL globally.
3358
3359 CONFIG_TPL_PAD_TO
3360 Image offset to which the TPL should be padded before appending
3361 the TPL payload. By default, this is defined as
Wolfgang Denkec7fbf52013-10-04 17:43:24 +02003362 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE, or 0 if CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE is undefined.
3363 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO must be either 0, meaning to append the SPL
3364 payload without any padding, or >= CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE.
Ying Zhang2d2e3b62013-08-16 15:16:15 +08003365
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003366Modem Support:
3367--------------
3368
Wolfgang Denk8f399b32011-05-01 20:44:23 +02003369[so far only for SMDK2400 boards]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003370
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003371- Modem support enable:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003372 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT
3373
3374- RTS/CTS Flow control enable:
3375 CONFIG_HWFLOW
3376
3377- Modem debug support:
3378 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT_DEBUG
3379
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003380 Enables debugging stuff (char screen[1024], dbg())
3381 for modem support. Useful only with BDI2000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003382
wdenkc0aa5c52003-12-06 19:49:23 +00003383- Interrupt support (PPC):
3384
wdenk1ebf41e2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003385 There are common interrupt_init() and timer_interrupt()
3386 for all PPC archs. interrupt_init() calls interrupt_init_cpu()
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003387 for CPU specific initialization. interrupt_init_cpu()
wdenk1ebf41e2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003388 should set decrementer_count to appropriate value. If
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003389 CPU resets decrementer automatically after interrupt
wdenk1ebf41e2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003390 (ppc4xx) it should set decrementer_count to zero.
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003391 timer_interrupt() calls timer_interrupt_cpu() for CPU
wdenk1ebf41e2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003392 specific handling. If board has watchdog / status_led
3393 / other_activity_monitor it works automatically from
3394 general timer_interrupt().
wdenkc0aa5c52003-12-06 19:49:23 +00003395
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003396- General:
3397
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003398 In the target system modem support is enabled when a
3399 specific key (key combination) is pressed during
3400 power-on. Otherwise U-Boot will boot normally
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003401 (autoboot). The key_pressed() function is called from
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003402 board_init(). Currently key_pressed() is a dummy
3403 function, returning 1 and thus enabling modem
3404 initialization.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003405
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003406 If there are no modem init strings in the
3407 environment, U-Boot proceed to autoboot; the
3408 previous output (banner, info printfs) will be
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003409 suppressed, though.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003410
3411 See also: doc/README.Modem
3412
Helmut Raigerd5a184b2011-10-20 04:19:47 +00003413Board initialization settings:
3414------------------------------
3415
3416During Initialization u-boot calls a number of board specific functions
3417to allow the preparation of board specific prerequisites, e.g. pin setup
3418before drivers are initialized. To enable these callbacks the
3419following configuration macros have to be defined. Currently this is
3420architecture specific, so please check arch/your_architecture/lib/board.c
3421typically in board_init_f() and board_init_r().
3422
3423- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_F: Call board_early_init_f()
3424- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_R: Call board_early_init_r()
3425- CONFIG_BOARD_LATE_INIT: Call board_late_init()
3426- CONFIG_BOARD_POSTCLK_INIT: Call board_postclk_init()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003427
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003428Configuration Settings:
3429-----------------------
3430
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003431- CONFIG_SYS_LONGHELP: Defined when you want long help messages included;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003432 undefine this when you're short of memory.
3433
Peter Tyserdfb72b82009-01-27 18:03:12 -06003434- CONFIG_SYS_HELP_CMD_WIDTH: Defined when you want to override the default
3435 width of the commands listed in the 'help' command output.
3436
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003437- CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT: This is what U-Boot prints on the console to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003438 prompt for user input.
3439
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003440- CONFIG_SYS_CBSIZE: Buffer size for input from the Console
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003441
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003442- CONFIG_SYS_PBSIZE: Buffer size for Console output
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003443
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003444- CONFIG_SYS_MAXARGS: max. Number of arguments accepted for monitor commands
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003445
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003446- CONFIG_SYS_BARGSIZE: Buffer size for Boot Arguments which are passed to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003447 the application (usually a Linux kernel) when it is
3448 booted
3449
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003450- CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003451 List of legal baudrate settings for this board.
3452
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003453- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_INFO_QUIET
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003454 Suppress display of console information at boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003455
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003456- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003457 If the board specific function
3458 extern int overwrite_console (void);
3459 returns 1, the stdin, stderr and stdout are switched to the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003460 serial port, else the settings in the environment are used.
3461
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003462- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_OVERWRITE_ROUTINE
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003463 Enable the call to overwrite_console().
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003464
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003465- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_ENV_OVERWRITE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003466 Enable overwrite of previous console environment settings.
3467
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003468- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_START, CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_END:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003469 Begin and End addresses of the area used by the
3470 simple memory test.
3471
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003472- CONFIG_SYS_ALT_MEMTEST:
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003473 Enable an alternate, more extensive memory test.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003474
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003475- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_SCRATCH:
wdenk5958f4a2003-09-18 09:21:33 +00003476 Scratch address used by the alternate memory test
3477 You only need to set this if address zero isn't writeable
3478
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003479- CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE (PPC only):
3480 If CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE is defined in the board config header,
Stefan Roesea13709f2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003481 this specified memory area will get subtracted from the top
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003482 (end) of RAM and won't get "touched" at all by U-Boot. By
Stefan Roesea13709f2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003483 fixing up gd->ram_size the Linux kernel should gets passed
3484 the now "corrected" memory size and won't touch it either.
3485 This should work for arch/ppc and arch/powerpc. Only Linux
Stefan Roese37f31bf2008-03-28 11:02:53 +01003486 board ports in arch/powerpc with bootwrapper support that
Stefan Roesea13709f2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003487 recalculate the memory size from the SDRAM controller setup
Stefan Roese37f31bf2008-03-28 11:02:53 +01003488 will have to get fixed in Linux additionally.
Stefan Roesea13709f2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003489
3490 This option can be used as a workaround for the 440EPx/GRx
3491 CHIP 11 errata where the last 256 bytes in SDRAM shouldn't
3492 be touched.
3493
3494 WARNING: Please make sure that this value is a multiple of
3495 the Linux page size (normally 4k). If this is not the case,
3496 then the end address of the Linux memory will be located at a
3497 non page size aligned address and this could cause major
3498 problems.
3499
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003500- CONFIG_SYS_LOADS_BAUD_CHANGE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003501 Enable temporary baudrate change while serial download
3502
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003503- CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003504 Physical start address of SDRAM. _Must_ be 0 here.
3505
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003506- CONFIG_SYS_MBIO_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003507 Physical start address of Motherboard I/O (if using a
3508 Cogent motherboard)
3509
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003510- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003511 Physical start address of Flash memory.
3512
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003513- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003514 Physical start address of boot monitor code (set by
3515 make config files to be same as the text base address
Wolfgang Denk0708bc62010-10-07 21:51:12 +02003516 (CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE) used when linking) - same as
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003517 CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE when booting from flash.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003518
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003519- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_LEN:
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003520 Size of memory reserved for monitor code, used to
3521 determine _at_compile_time_ (!) if the environment is
3522 embedded within the U-Boot image, or in a separate
3523 flash sector.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003524
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003525- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003526 Size of DRAM reserved for malloc() use.
3527
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003528- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN:
Stefan Roese5d5ce292006-03-13 11:16:36 +01003529 Normally compressed uImages are limited to an
3530 uncompressed size of 8 MBytes. If this is not enough,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003531 you can define CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN in your board config file
Stefan Roese5d5ce292006-03-13 11:16:36 +01003532 to adjust this setting to your needs.
3533
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003534- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003535 Maximum size of memory mapped by the startup code of
3536 the Linux kernel; all data that must be processed by
Bartlomiej Siekac5648c82008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003537 the Linux kernel (bd_info, boot arguments, FDT blob if
3538 used) must be put below this limit, unless "bootm_low"
Robert P. J. Day832d36e2013-09-16 07:15:45 -04003539 environment variable is defined and non-zero. In such case
Bartlomiej Siekac5648c82008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003540 all data for the Linux kernel must be between "bootm_low"
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003541 and "bootm_low" + CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. The environment
Grant Likely26396382011-03-28 09:58:43 +00003542 variable "bootm_mapsize" will override the value of
3543 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. If CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is undefined,
3544 then the value in "bootm_size" will be used instead.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003545
John Rigbyeea8e692010-10-13 13:57:35 -06003546- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_RAMDISK_HIGH:
3547 Enable initrd_high functionality. If defined then the
3548 initrd_high feature is enabled and the bootm ramdisk subcommand
3549 is enabled.
3550
3551- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_CMDLINE:
3552 Enables allocating and saving kernel cmdline in space between
3553 "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
3554
3555- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_KBD:
3556 Enables allocating and saving a kernel copy of the bd_info in
3557 space between "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
3558
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003559- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003560 Max number of Flash memory banks
3561
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003562- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_SECT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003563 Max number of sectors on a Flash chip
3564
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003565- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_ERASE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003566 Timeout for Flash erase operations (in ms)
3567
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003568- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_WRITE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003569 Timeout for Flash write operations (in ms)
3570
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003571- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_LOCK_TOUT
wdenkdccbda02003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003572 Timeout for Flash set sector lock bit operation (in ms)
3573
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003574- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_UNLOCK_TOUT
wdenkdccbda02003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003575 Timeout for Flash clear lock bits operation (in ms)
3576
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003577- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_PROTECTION
wdenkdccbda02003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003578 If defined, hardware flash sectors protection is used
3579 instead of U-Boot software protection.
3580
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003581- CONFIG_SYS_DIRECT_FLASH_TFTP:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003582
3583 Enable TFTP transfers directly to flash memory;
3584 without this option such a download has to be
3585 performed in two steps: (1) download to RAM, and (2)
3586 copy from RAM to flash.
3587
3588 The two-step approach is usually more reliable, since
3589 you can check if the download worked before you erase
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003590 the flash, but in some situations (when system RAM is
3591 too limited to allow for a temporary copy of the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003592 downloaded image) this option may be very useful.
3593
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003594- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_CFI:
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003595 Define if the flash driver uses extra elements in the
wdenk2cefd152004-02-08 22:55:38 +00003596 common flash structure for storing flash geometry.
3597
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD8d94c232008-08-13 01:40:42 +02003598- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_DRIVER
wdenk2cefd152004-02-08 22:55:38 +00003599 This option also enables the building of the cfi_flash driver
3600 in the drivers directory
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003601
Piotr Ziecik3e939e92008-11-17 15:57:58 +01003602- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_MTD
3603 This option enables the building of the cfi_mtd driver
3604 in the drivers directory. The driver exports CFI flash
3605 to the MTD layer.
3606
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003607- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_USE_BUFFER_WRITE
Guennadi Liakhovetski183284f2008-04-03 13:36:02 +02003608 Use buffered writes to flash.
3609
3610- CONFIG_FLASH_SPANSION_S29WS_N
3611 s29ws-n MirrorBit flash has non-standard addresses for buffered
3612 write commands.
3613
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003614- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_QUIET_TEST
Stefan Roesec443fe92005-11-22 13:20:42 +01003615 If this option is defined, the common CFI flash doesn't
3616 print it's warning upon not recognized FLASH banks. This
3617 is useful, if some of the configured banks are only
3618 optionally available.
3619
Jerry Van Barenaae73572008-03-08 13:48:01 -05003620- CONFIG_FLASH_SHOW_PROGRESS
3621 If defined (must be an integer), print out countdown
3622 digits and dots. Recommended value: 45 (9..1) for 80
3623 column displays, 15 (3..1) for 40 column displays.
3624
Stefan Roesed20cba52013-04-04 15:53:14 +02003625- CONFIG_FLASH_VERIFY
3626 If defined, the content of the flash (destination) is compared
3627 against the source after the write operation. An error message
3628 will be printed when the contents are not identical.
3629 Please note that this option is useless in nearly all cases,
3630 since such flash programming errors usually are detected earlier
3631 while unprotecting/erasing/programming. Please only enable
3632 this option if you really know what you are doing.
3633
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003634- CONFIG_SYS_RX_ETH_BUFFER:
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003635 Defines the number of Ethernet receive buffers. On some
3636 Ethernet controllers it is recommended to set this value
stroese94ef1cf2003-06-05 15:39:44 +00003637 to 8 or even higher (EEPRO100 or 405 EMAC), since all
3638 buffers can be full shortly after enabling the interface
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003639 on high Ethernet traffic.
stroese94ef1cf2003-06-05 15:39:44 +00003640 Defaults to 4 if not defined.
3641
Wolfgang Denk460a9ff2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02003642- CONFIG_ENV_MAX_ENTRIES
3643
Wolfgang Denk1136f692010-10-27 22:48:30 +02003644 Maximum number of entries in the hash table that is used
3645 internally to store the environment settings. The default
3646 setting is supposed to be generous and should work in most
3647 cases. This setting can be used to tune behaviour; see
3648 lib/hashtable.c for details.
Wolfgang Denk460a9ff2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02003649
Joe Hershberger71497d02012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003650- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
3651- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
Robert P. J. Day832d36e2013-09-16 07:15:45 -04003652 Enable validation of the values given to environment variables when
Joe Hershberger71497d02012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003653 calling env set. Variables can be restricted to only decimal,
3654 hexadecimal, or boolean. If CONFIG_CMD_NET is also defined,
3655 the variables can also be restricted to IP address or MAC address.
3656
3657 The format of the list is:
3658 type_attribute = [s|d|x|b|i|m]
Joe Hershberger6fe26c92012-12-11 22:16:34 -06003659 access_atribute = [a|r|o|c]
3660 attributes = type_attribute[access_atribute]
Joe Hershberger71497d02012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003661 entry = variable_name[:attributes]
3662 list = entry[,list]
3663
3664 The type attributes are:
3665 s - String (default)
3666 d - Decimal
3667 x - Hexadecimal
3668 b - Boolean ([1yYtT|0nNfF])
3669 i - IP address
3670 m - MAC address
3671
Joe Hershberger6fe26c92012-12-11 22:16:34 -06003672 The access attributes are:
3673 a - Any (default)
3674 r - Read-only
3675 o - Write-once
3676 c - Change-default
3677
Joe Hershberger71497d02012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003678 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
3679 Define this to a list (string) to define the ".flags"
3680 envirnoment variable in the default or embedded environment.
3681
3682 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
3683 Define this to a list (string) to define validation that
3684 should be done if an entry is not found in the ".flags"
3685 environment variable. To override a setting in the static
3686 list, simply add an entry for the same variable name to the
3687 ".flags" variable.
3688
Joe Hershberger6fe26c92012-12-11 22:16:34 -06003689- CONFIG_ENV_ACCESS_IGNORE_FORCE
3690 If defined, don't allow the -f switch to env set override variable
3691 access flags.
3692
Simon Glass66828322013-03-08 13:45:27 +00003693- CONFIG_SYS_GENERIC_BOARD
3694 This selects the architecture-generic board system instead of the
3695 architecture-specific board files. It is intended to move boards
3696 to this new framework over time. Defining this will disable the
3697 arch/foo/lib/board.c file and use common/board_f.c and
3698 common/board_r.c instead. To use this option your architecture
3699 must support it (i.e. must define __HAVE_ARCH_GENERIC_BOARD in
3700 its config.mk file). If you find problems enabling this option on
3701 your board please report the problem and send patches!
3702
Simon Glass9c9f44a2013-03-11 07:06:48 +00003703- CONFIG_SYS_SYM_OFFSETS
3704 This is set by architectures that use offsets for link symbols
3705 instead of absolute values. So bss_start is obtained using an
3706 offset _bss_start_ofs from CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE, rather than
3707 directly. You should not need to touch this setting.
3708
Lokesh Vutla100c2d82013-04-17 20:49:40 +00003709- CONFIG_OMAP_PLATFORM_RESET_TIME_MAX_USEC (OMAP only)
3710 This is set by OMAP boards for the max time that reset should
3711 be asserted. See doc/README.omap-reset-time for details on how
3712 the value can be calulated on a given board.
Simon Glass9c9f44a2013-03-11 07:06:48 +00003713
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003714The following definitions that deal with the placement and management
3715of environment data (variable area); in general, we support the
3716following configurations:
3717
Mike Frysinger63b8f122011-07-08 10:44:25 +00003718- CONFIG_BUILD_ENVCRC:
3719
3720 Builds up envcrc with the target environment so that external utils
3721 may easily extract it and embed it in final U-Boot images.
3722
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD53db4cd2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02003723- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003724
3725 Define this if the environment is in flash memory.
3726
3727 a) The environment occupies one whole flash sector, which is
3728 "embedded" in the text segment with the U-Boot code. This
3729 happens usually with "bottom boot sector" or "top boot
3730 sector" type flash chips, which have several smaller
3731 sectors at the start or the end. For instance, such a
3732 layout can have sector sizes of 8, 2x4, 16, Nx32 kB. In
3733 such a case you would place the environment in one of the
3734 4 kB sectors - with U-Boot code before and after it. With
3735 "top boot sector" type flash chips, you would put the
3736 environment in one of the last sectors, leaving a gap
3737 between U-Boot and the environment.
3738
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD7e1cda62008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003739 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003740
3741 Offset of environment data (variable area) to the
3742 beginning of flash memory; for instance, with bottom boot
3743 type flash chips the second sector can be used: the offset
3744 for this sector is given here.
3745
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003746 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET is used relative to CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003747
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD7e1cda62008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003748 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003749
3750 This is just another way to specify the start address of
3751 the flash sector containing the environment (instead of
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD7e1cda62008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003752 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003753
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD7e1cda62008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003754 - CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003755
3756 Size of the sector containing the environment.
3757
3758
3759 b) Sometimes flash chips have few, equal sized, BIG sectors.
3760 In such a case you don't want to spend a whole sector for
3761 the environment.
3762
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD7e1cda62008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003763 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003764
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD53db4cd2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02003765 If you use this in combination with CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD7e1cda62008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003766 and CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE, you can specify to use only a part
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003767 of this flash sector for the environment. This saves
3768 memory for the RAM copy of the environment.
3769
3770 It may also save flash memory if you decide to use this
3771 when your environment is "embedded" within U-Boot code,
3772 since then the remainder of the flash sector could be used
3773 for U-Boot code. It should be pointed out that this is
3774 STRONGLY DISCOURAGED from a robustness point of view:
3775 updating the environment in flash makes it always
3776 necessary to erase the WHOLE sector. If something goes
3777 wrong before the contents has been restored from a copy in
3778 RAM, your target system will be dead.
3779
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD7e1cda62008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003780 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR_REDUND
3781 CONFIG_ENV_SIZE_REDUND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003782
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003783 These settings describe a second storage area used to hold
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003784 a redundant copy of the environment data, so that there is
wdenkb02744a2003-04-05 00:53:31 +00003785 a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure during
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003786 a "saveenv" operation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003787
3788BE CAREFUL! Any changes to the flash layout, and some changes to the
3789source code will make it necessary to adapt <board>/u-boot.lds*
3790accordingly!
3791
3792
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDfdb79c32008-09-10 22:47:59 +02003793- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NVRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003794
3795 Define this if you have some non-volatile memory device
3796 (NVRAM, battery buffered SRAM) which you want to use for the
3797 environment.
3798
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD7e1cda62008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003799 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
3800 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003801
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003802 These two #defines are used to determine the memory area you
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003803 want to use for environment. It is assumed that this memory
3804 can just be read and written to, without any special
3805 provision.
3806
3807BE CAREFUL! The first access to the environment happens quite early
3808in U-Boot initalization (when we try to get the setting of for the
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003809console baudrate). You *MUST* have mapped your NVRAM area then, or
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003810U-Boot will hang.
3811
3812Please note that even with NVRAM we still use a copy of the
3813environment in RAM: we could work on NVRAM directly, but we want to
3814keep settings there always unmodified except somebody uses "saveenv"
3815to save the current settings.
3816
3817
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDe46af642008-09-05 09:19:30 +02003818- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_EEPROM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003819
3820 Use this if you have an EEPROM or similar serial access
3821 device and a driver for it.
3822
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD7e1cda62008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003823 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
3824 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003825
3826 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the
3827 environment area within the total memory of your EEPROM.
3828
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003829 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003830 If defined, specified the chip address of the EEPROM device.
3831 The default address is zero.
3832
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003833 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_BITS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003834 If defined, the number of bits used to address bytes in a
3835 single page in the EEPROM device. A 64 byte page, for example
3836 would require six bits.
3837
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003838 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_DELAY_MS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003839 If defined, the number of milliseconds to delay between
wdenk544e9732004-02-06 23:19:44 +00003840 page writes. The default is zero milliseconds.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003841
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003842 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003843 The length in bytes of the EEPROM memory array address. Note
3844 that this is NOT the chip address length!
3845
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003846 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_OVERFLOW:
wdenk20c98a62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00003847 EEPROM chips that implement "address overflow" are ones
3848 like Catalyst 24WC04/08/16 which has 9/10/11 bits of
3849 address and the extra bits end up in the "chip address" bit
3850 slots. This makes a 24WC08 (1Kbyte) chip look like four 256
3851 byte chips.
3852
3853 Note that we consider the length of the address field to
3854 still be one byte because the extra address bits are hidden
3855 in the chip address.
3856
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003857 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003858 The size in bytes of the EEPROM device.
3859
Heiko Schocher9bb0dd52010-01-07 08:55:40 +01003860 - CONFIG_ENV_EEPROM_IS_ON_I2C
3861 define this, if you have I2C and SPI activated, and your
3862 EEPROM, which holds the environment, is on the I2C bus.
3863
3864 - CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS
3865 if you have an Environment on an EEPROM reached over
3866 I2C muxes, you can define here, how to reach this
3867 EEPROM. For example:
3868
Heiko Schocher479a4cf2013-01-29 08:53:15 +01003869 #define CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS 1
Heiko Schocher9bb0dd52010-01-07 08:55:40 +01003870
3871 EEPROM which holds the environment, is reached over
3872 a pca9547 i2c mux with address 0x70, channel 3.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003873
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD2b14d2b2008-09-10 22:47:58 +02003874- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_DATAFLASH:
wdenk86765902003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003875
wdenk1ebf41e2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003876 Define this if you have a DataFlash memory device which you
wdenk86765902003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003877 want to use for the environment.
3878
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD7e1cda62008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003879 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
3880 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
3881 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk86765902003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003882
3883 These three #defines specify the offset and size of the
3884 environment area within the total memory of your DataFlash placed
3885 at the specified address.
3886
Liu Gang85bcd732012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003887- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_REMOTE:
3888
3889 Define this if you have a remote memory space which you
3890 want to use for the local device's environment.
3891
3892 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
3893 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
3894
3895 These two #defines specify the address and size of the
3896 environment area within the remote memory space. The
3897 local device can get the environment from remote memory
Liu Gang357bf5a2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003898 space by SRIO or PCIE links.
Liu Gang85bcd732012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003899
3900BE CAREFUL! For some special cases, the local device can not use
3901"saveenv" command. For example, the local device will get the
Liu Gang357bf5a2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003902environment stored in a remote NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE link,
3903but it can not erase, write this NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE interface.
Liu Gang85bcd732012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003904
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDdda84dd2008-09-10 22:47:58 +02003905- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NAND:
wdenk79b59372004-06-09 14:58:14 +00003906
3907 Define this if you have a NAND device which you want to use
3908 for the environment.
3909
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD7e1cda62008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003910 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
3911 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk79b59372004-06-09 14:58:14 +00003912
3913 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the environment
Scott Wood08239322010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003914 area within the first NAND device. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET must be
3915 aligned to an erase block boundary.
wdenk86765902003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003916
Scott Wood08239322010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003917 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
Markus Klotzbuecher5d113e02006-03-20 18:02:44 +01003918
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD7e1cda62008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003919 This setting describes a second storage area of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE
Scott Wood08239322010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003920 size used to hold a redundant copy of the environment data, so
3921 that there is a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003922 during a "saveenv" operation. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_RENDUND must be
Scott Wood08239322010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003923 aligned to an erase block boundary.
3924
3925 - CONFIG_ENV_RANGE (optional):
3926
3927 Specifies the length of the region in which the environment
3928 can be written. This should be a multiple of the NAND device's
3929 block size. Specifying a range with more erase blocks than
3930 are needed to hold CONFIG_ENV_SIZE allows bad blocks within
3931 the range to be avoided.
3932
3933 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB (optional):
Markus Klotzbuecher5d113e02006-03-20 18:02:44 +01003934
Scott Wood08239322010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003935 Enables support for dynamically retrieving the offset of the
3936 environment from block zero's out-of-band data. The
3937 "nand env.oob" command can be used to record this offset.
3938 Currently, CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND is not supported when
3939 using CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB.
Markus Klotzbuecher5d113e02006-03-20 18:02:44 +01003940
Guennadi Liakhovetskifad24442009-05-18 16:07:22 +02003941- CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST
3942
3943 Defines address in RAM to which the nand_spl code should copy the
3944 environment. If redundant environment is used, it will be copied to
3945 CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST + CONFIG_ENV_SIZE.
3946
Joe Hershberger0c5faa82013-04-08 10:32:51 +00003947- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_UBI:
3948
3949 Define this if you have an UBI volume that you want to use for the
3950 environment. This has the benefit of wear-leveling the environment
3951 accesses, which is important on NAND.
3952
3953 - CONFIG_ENV_UBI_PART:
3954
3955 Define this to a string that is the mtd partition containing the UBI.
3956
3957 - CONFIG_ENV_UBI_VOLUME:
3958
3959 Define this to the name of the volume that you want to store the
3960 environment in.
3961
Joe Hershbergerdb14e862013-04-08 10:32:52 +00003962 - CONFIG_ENV_UBI_VOLUME_REDUND:
3963
3964 Define this to the name of another volume to store a second copy of
3965 the environment in. This will enable redundant environments in UBI.
3966 It is assumed that both volumes are in the same MTD partition.
3967
Joe Hershberger0c5faa82013-04-08 10:32:51 +00003968 - CONFIG_UBI_SILENCE_MSG
3969 - CONFIG_UBIFS_SILENCE_MSG
3970
3971 You will probably want to define these to avoid a really noisy system
3972 when storing the env in UBI.
3973
Stephen Warreneedcacd2013-06-11 15:14:00 -06003974- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_MMC:
3975
3976 Define this if you have an MMC device which you want to use for the
3977 environment.
3978
3979 - CONFIG_SYS_MMC_ENV_DEV:
3980
3981 Specifies which MMC device the environment is stored in.
3982
3983 - CONFIG_SYS_MMC_ENV_PART (optional):
3984
3985 Specifies which MMC partition the environment is stored in. If not
3986 set, defaults to partition 0, the user area. Common values might be
3987 1 (first MMC boot partition), 2 (second MMC boot partition).
3988
3989 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
3990 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
3991
3992 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the environment
3993 area within the specified MMC device.
3994
Stephen Warren24dc2032013-06-11 15:14:02 -06003995 If offset is positive (the usual case), it is treated as relative to
3996 the start of the MMC partition. If offset is negative, it is treated
3997 as relative to the end of the MMC partition. This can be useful if
3998 your board may be fitted with different MMC devices, which have
3999 different sizes for the MMC partitions, and you always want the
4000 environment placed at the very end of the partition, to leave the
4001 maximum possible space before it, to store other data.
4002
Stephen Warreneedcacd2013-06-11 15:14:00 -06004003 These two values are in units of bytes, but must be aligned to an
4004 MMC sector boundary.
4005
4006 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
4007
4008 Specifies a second storage area, of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE size, used to
4009 hold a redundant copy of the environment data. This provides a
4010 valid backup copy in case the other copy is corrupted, e.g. due
4011 to a power failure during a "saveenv" operation.
4012
Stephen Warren24dc2032013-06-11 15:14:02 -06004013 This value may also be positive or negative; this is handled in the
4014 same way as CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET.
4015
Stephen Warreneedcacd2013-06-11 15:14:00 -06004016 This value is also in units of bytes, but must also be aligned to
4017 an MMC sector boundary.
4018
4019 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE_REDUND (optional):
4020
4021 This value need not be set, even when CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND is
4022 set. If this value is set, it must be set to the same value as
4023 CONFIG_ENV_SIZE.
4024
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004025- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_INIT_OFFSET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004026
4027 Defines offset to the initial SPI buffer area in DPRAM. The
4028 area is used at an early stage (ROM part) if the environment
4029 is configured to reside in the SPI EEPROM: We need a 520 byte
4030 scratch DPRAM area. It is used between the two initialization
4031 calls (spi_init_f() and spi_init_r()). A value of 0xB00 seems
4032 to be a good choice since it makes it far enough from the
4033 start of the data area as well as from the stack pointer.
4034
Bruce Adleredecc942007-11-02 13:15:42 -07004035Please note that the environment is read-only until the monitor
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004036has been relocated to RAM and a RAM copy of the environment has been
Wolfgang Denk76af2782010-07-24 21:55:43 +02004037created; also, when using EEPROM you will have to use getenv_f()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004038until then to read environment variables.
4039
wdenk8dba0502003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004040The environment is protected by a CRC32 checksum. Before the monitor
4041is relocated into RAM, as a result of a bad CRC you will be working
4042with the compiled-in default environment - *silently*!!! [This is
4043necessary, because the first environment variable we need is the
4044"baudrate" setting for the console - if we have a bad CRC, we don't
4045have any device yet where we could complain.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004046
4047Note: once the monitor has been relocated, then it will complain if
4048the default environment is used; a new CRC is computed as soon as you
wdenk8dba0502003-03-31 16:34:49 +00004049use the "saveenv" command to store a valid environment.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004050
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004051- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_ECHO_LINK_DOWN:
wdenk9c53f402003-10-15 23:53:47 +00004052 Echo the inverted Ethernet link state to the fault LED.
wdenk49c3f672003-10-08 22:33:00 +00004053
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004054 Note: If this option is active, then CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR
wdenk49c3f672003-10-08 22:33:00 +00004055 also needs to be defined.
4056
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004057- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR:
wdenk9c53f402003-10-15 23:53:47 +00004058 MII address of the PHY to check for the Ethernet link state.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004059
Ron Madriddfa028a2009-02-18 14:30:44 -08004060- CONFIG_NS16550_MIN_FUNCTIONS:
4061 Define this if you desire to only have use of the NS16550_init
4062 and NS16550_putc functions for the serial driver located at
4063 drivers/serial/ns16550.c. This option is useful for saving
4064 space for already greatly restricted images, including but not
4065 limited to NAND_SPL configurations.
4066
Simon Glass28a9e332012-11-30 13:01:18 +00004067- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO
4068 Display information about the board that U-Boot is running on
4069 when U-Boot starts up. The board function checkboard() is called
4070 to do this.
4071
Simon Glasse8822012012-11-30 13:01:19 +00004072- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO_LATE
4073 Similar to the previous option, but display this information
4074 later, once stdio is running and output goes to the LCD, if
4075 present.
4076
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004077Low Level (hardware related) configuration options:
wdenkc8434db2003-03-26 06:55:25 +00004078---------------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004079
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004080- CONFIG_SYS_CACHELINE_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004081 Cache Line Size of the CPU.
4082
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004083- CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004084 Default address of the IMMR after system reset.
wdenk2bb11052003-07-17 23:16:40 +00004085
wdenk9c53f402003-10-15 23:53:47 +00004086 Needed on some 8260 systems (MPC8260ADS, PQ2FADS-ZU,
4087 and RPXsuper) to be able to adjust the position of
4088 the IMMR register after a reset.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004089
Timur Tabid8f341c2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05004090- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT:
4091 Default (power-on reset) physical address of CCSR on Freescale
4092 PowerPC SOCs.
4093
4094- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR:
4095 Virtual address of CCSR. On a 32-bit build, this is typically
4096 the same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT.
4097
4098 CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR must also be set to this value,
4099 for cross-platform code that uses that macro instead.
4100
4101- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS:
4102 Physical address of CCSR. CCSR can be relocated to a new
4103 physical address, if desired. In this case, this macro should
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004104 be set to that address. Otherwise, it should be set to the
Timur Tabid8f341c2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05004105 same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT. For example, CCSR
4106 is typically relocated on 36-bit builds. It is recommended
4107 that this macro be defined via the _HIGH and _LOW macros:
4108
4109 #define CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS ((CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH
4110 * 1ull) << 32 | CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW)
4111
4112- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH:
Wolfgang Denkd590fb12011-10-07 09:58:21 +02004113 Bits 33-36 of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This value is typically
4114 either 0 (32-bit build) or 0xF (36-bit build). This macro is
Timur Tabid8f341c2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05004115 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
4116 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
4117
4118- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW:
4119 Lower 32-bits of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This macro is
4120 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
4121 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
4122
4123- CONFIG_SYS_CCSR_DO_NOT_RELOCATE:
4124 If this macro is defined, then CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS will be
4125 forced to a value that ensures that CCSR is not relocated.
4126
wdenk1272e232002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004127- Floppy Disk Support:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004128 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER
wdenk1272e232002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004129
4130 the default drive number (default value 0)
4131
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004132 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE
wdenk1272e232002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004133
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004134 defines the spacing between FDC chipset registers
wdenk1272e232002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004135 (default value 1)
4136
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004137 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET
wdenk1272e232002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004138
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004139 defines the offset of register from address. It
4140 depends on which part of the data bus is connected to
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004141 the FDC chipset. (default value 0)
wdenk1272e232002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004142
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004143 If CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET and
4144 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER are undefined, they take their
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004145 default value.
wdenk1272e232002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004146
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004147 if CONFIG_SYS_FDC_HW_INIT is defined, then the function
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004148 fdc_hw_init() is called at the beginning of the FDC
4149 setup. fdc_hw_init() must be provided by the board
4150 source code. It is used to make hardware dependant
4151 initializations.
wdenk1272e232002-11-10 22:06:23 +00004152
Macpaul Lind1e49942011-04-11 20:45:32 +00004153- CONFIG_IDE_AHB:
4154 Most IDE controllers were designed to be connected with PCI
4155 interface. Only few of them were designed for AHB interface.
4156 When software is doing ATA command and data transfer to
4157 IDE devices through IDE-AHB controller, some additional
4158 registers accessing to these kind of IDE-AHB controller
4159 is requierd.
4160
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004161- CONFIG_SYS_IMMR: Physical address of the Internal Memory.
wdenk07d7e6b2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004162 DO NOT CHANGE unless you know exactly what you're
wdenkb3a4a702004-12-10 11:40:40 +00004163 doing! (11-4) [MPC8xx/82xx systems only]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004164
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004165- CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004166
wdenkeb20ad32003-09-05 23:19:14 +00004167 Start address of memory area that can be used for
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004168 initial data and stack; please note that this must be
4169 writable memory that is working WITHOUT special
4170 initialization, i. e. you CANNOT use normal RAM which
4171 will become available only after programming the
4172 memory controller and running certain initialization
4173 sequences.
4174
4175 U-Boot uses the following memory types:
4176 - MPC8xx and MPC8260: IMMR (internal memory of the CPU)
4177 - MPC824X: data cache
4178 - PPC4xx: data cache
4179
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004180- CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004181
4182 Offset of the initial data structure in the memory
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004183 area defined by CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR. Usually
4184 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET is chosen such that the initial
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004185 data is located at the end of the available space
Wolfgang Denk1c2e98e2010-10-26 13:32:32 +02004186 (sometimes written as (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_SIZE -
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004187 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_DATA_SIZE), and the initial stack is just
4188 below that area (growing from (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR +
4189 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET) downward.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004190
4191 Note:
4192 On the MPC824X (or other systems that use the data
4193 cache for initial memory) the address chosen for
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004194 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR is basically arbitrary - it must
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004195 point to an otherwise UNUSED address space between
4196 the top of RAM and the start of the PCI space.
4197
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004198- CONFIG_SYS_SIUMCR: SIU Module Configuration (11-6)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004199
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004200- CONFIG_SYS_SYPCR: System Protection Control (11-9)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004201
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004202- CONFIG_SYS_TBSCR: Time Base Status and Control (11-26)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004203
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004204- CONFIG_SYS_PISCR: Periodic Interrupt Status and Control (11-31)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004205
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004206- CONFIG_SYS_PLPRCR: PLL, Low-Power, and Reset Control Register (15-30)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004207
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004208- CONFIG_SYS_SCCR: System Clock and reset Control Register (15-27)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004209
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004210- CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004211 SDRAM timing
4212
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004213- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004214 periodic timer for refresh
4215
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004216- CONFIG_SYS_DER: Debug Event Register (37-47)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004217
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004218- FLASH_BASE0_PRELIM, FLASH_BASE1_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_REMAP_OR_AM,
4219 CONFIG_SYS_PRELIM_OR_AM, CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_FLASH, CONFIG_SYS_OR0_REMAP,
4220 CONFIG_SYS_OR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_REMAP, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_PRELIM,
4221 CONFIG_SYS_BR1_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004222 Memory Controller Definitions: BR0/1 and OR0/1 (FLASH)
4223
4224- SDRAM_BASE2_PRELIM, SDRAM_BASE3_PRELIM, SDRAM_MAX_SIZE,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004225 CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM, CONFIG_SYS_OR2_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR2_PRELIM,
4226 CONFIG_SYS_OR3_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR3_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004227 Memory Controller Definitions: BR2/3 and OR2/3 (SDRAM)
4228
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004229- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_8K,
4230 CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_8K, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_8COL, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_9COL:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004231 Machine Mode Register and Memory Periodic Timer
4232 Prescaler definitions (SDRAM timing)
4233
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004234- CONFIG_SYS_I2C_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004235 enable I2C microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
4236 define relocation offset in DPRAM [DSP2]
4237
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004238- CONFIG_SYS_SMC_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SMC_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
Heiko Schocherc8148ed2008-01-11 01:12:07 +01004239 enable SMC microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
4240 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SMC1]
4241
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004242- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SPI_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004243 enable SPI microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
4244 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SCC4]
4245
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004246- CONFIG_SYS_USE_OSCCLK:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004247 Use OSCM clock mode on MBX8xx board. Be careful,
4248 wrong setting might damage your board. Read
4249 doc/README.MBX before setting this variable!
4250
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004251- CONFIG_SYS_CPM_POST_WORD_ADDR: (MPC8xx, MPC8260 only)
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00004252 Offset of the bootmode word in DPRAM used by post
4253 (Power On Self Tests). This definition overrides
4254 #define'd default value in commproc.h resp.
4255 cpm_8260.h.
wdenk2029f4d2002-11-21 23:11:29 +00004256
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004257- CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_PICMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
4258 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR0_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK0_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR1_LOCAL,
4259 CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK1_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_BUS,
4260 CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_MEM_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
4261 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_BUS, CPU_PCI_MEMIO_START,
4262 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR1_MASK_ATTRIB, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_LOCAL,
4263 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_IO_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_SIZE,
4264 CONFIG_SYS_POCMR2_MASK_ATTRIB: (MPC826x only)
Stefan Roese88fbf932010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004265 Overrides the default PCI memory map in arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8260/pci.c if set.
wdenkbf2f8c92003-05-22 22:52:13 +00004266
Dirk Eibach378d1ca2009-02-09 08:18:34 +01004267- CONFIG_PCI_DISABLE_PCIE:
4268 Disable PCI-Express on systems where it is supported but not
4269 required.
4270
Andrew Sharp61d47ca2012-08-29 14:16:32 +00004271- CONFIG_PCI_ENUM_ONLY
4272 Only scan through and get the devices on the busses.
4273 Don't do any setup work, presumably because someone or
4274 something has already done it, and we don't need to do it
4275 a second time. Useful for platforms that are pre-booted
4276 by coreboot or similar.
4277
Gabor Juhosb4458732013-05-30 07:06:12 +00004278- CONFIG_PCI_INDIRECT_BRIDGE:
4279 Enable support for indirect PCI bridges.
4280
Kumar Gala8975d7a2010-12-30 12:09:53 -06004281- CONFIG_SYS_SRIO:
4282 Chip has SRIO or not
4283
4284- CONFIG_SRIO1:
4285 Board has SRIO 1 port available
4286
4287- CONFIG_SRIO2:
4288 Board has SRIO 2 port available
4289
Liu Gang27afb9c2013-05-07 16:30:46 +08004290- CONFIG_SRIO_PCIE_BOOT_MASTER
4291 Board can support master function for Boot from SRIO and PCIE
4292
Kumar Gala8975d7a2010-12-30 12:09:53 -06004293- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_VIRT:
4294 Virtual Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
4295
4296- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_PHYS:
4297 Physical Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
4298
4299- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_SIZE:
4300 Size of SRIO port 'n' memory region
4301
Fabio Estevamf17e8782013-04-11 09:35:34 +00004302- CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BUSWIDTH_16BIT
4303 Defined to tell the NAND controller that the NAND chip is using
4304 a 16 bit bus.
4305 Not all NAND drivers use this symbol.
Fabio Estevam417052b2013-04-11 09:35:35 +00004306 Example of drivers that use it:
Fabio Estevamf17e8782013-04-11 09:35:34 +00004307 - drivers/mtd/nand/ndfc.c
Fabio Estevam417052b2013-04-11 09:35:35 +00004308 - drivers/mtd/nand/mxc_nand.c
Alex Watermancd6aae32011-05-19 15:08:36 -04004309
4310- CONFIG_SYS_NDFC_EBC0_CFG
4311 Sets the EBC0_CFG register for the NDFC. If not defined
4312 a default value will be used.
4313
Ben Warren45657152006-09-07 16:50:54 -04004314- CONFIG_SPD_EEPROM
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004315 Get DDR timing information from an I2C EEPROM. Common
4316 with pluggable memory modules such as SODIMMs
4317
Ben Warren45657152006-09-07 16:50:54 -04004318 SPD_EEPROM_ADDRESS
4319 I2C address of the SPD EEPROM
4320
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004321- CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004322 If SPD EEPROM is on an I2C bus other than the first
4323 one, specify here. Note that the value must resolve
4324 to something your driver can deal with.
Ben Warren45657152006-09-07 16:50:54 -04004325
York Sune73cc042011-06-07 09:42:16 +08004326- CONFIG_SYS_DDR_RAW_TIMING
4327 Get DDR timing information from other than SPD. Common with
4328 soldered DDR chips onboard without SPD. DDR raw timing
4329 parameters are extracted from datasheet and hard-coded into
4330 header files or board specific files.
4331
York Sunbd495cf2011-09-16 13:21:35 -07004332- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_INTERACTIVE
4333 Enable interactive DDR debugging. See doc/README.fsl-ddr.
4334
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004335- CONFIG_SYS_83XX_DDR_USES_CS0
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004336 Only for 83xx systems. If specified, then DDR should
4337 be configured using CS0 and CS1 instead of CS2 and CS3.
Timur Tabi054838e2006-10-31 18:44:42 -06004338
wdenk6203e402004-04-18 10:13:26 +00004339- CONFIG_ETHER_ON_FEC[12]
4340 Define to enable FEC[12] on a 8xx series processor.
4341
4342- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY
4343 Define to the hardcoded PHY address which corresponds
wdenk05939202004-04-18 17:39:38 +00004344 to the given FEC; i. e.
4345 #define CONFIG_FEC1_PHY 4
wdenk6203e402004-04-18 10:13:26 +00004346 means that the PHY with address 4 is connected to FEC1
4347
4348 When set to -1, means to probe for first available.
4349
4350- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY_NORXERR
4351 The PHY does not have a RXERR line (RMII only).
4352 (so program the FEC to ignore it).
4353
4354- CONFIG_RMII
4355 Enable RMII mode for all FECs.
4356 Note that this is a global option, we can't
4357 have one FEC in standard MII mode and another in RMII mode.
4358
wdenk20c98a62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00004359- CONFIG_CRC32_VERIFY
4360 Add a verify option to the crc32 command.
4361 The syntax is:
4362
4363 => crc32 -v <address> <count> <crc32>
4364
4365 Where address/count indicate a memory area
4366 and crc32 is the correct crc32 which the
4367 area should have.
4368
wdenk64519362004-07-11 17:40:54 +00004369- CONFIG_LOOPW
4370 Add the "loopw" memory command. This only takes effect if
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -05004371 the memory commands are activated globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
wdenk64519362004-07-11 17:40:54 +00004372
stroesecc3af832004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004373- CONFIG_MX_CYCLIC
4374 Add the "mdc" and "mwc" memory commands. These are cyclic
4375 "md/mw" commands.
4376 Examples:
4377
wdenk07d7e6b2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004378 => mdc.b 10 4 500
stroesecc3af832004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004379 This command will print 4 bytes (10,11,12,13) each 500 ms.
4380
wdenk07d7e6b2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004381 => mwc.l 100 12345678 10
stroesecc3af832004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004382 This command will write 12345678 to address 100 all 10 ms.
4383
wdenk07d7e6b2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00004384 This only takes effect if the memory commands are activated
Jon Loeligerc1da5c92007-06-11 19:03:39 -05004385 globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
stroesecc3af832004-12-16 18:46:55 +00004386
wdenk3d3d99f2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00004387- CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT
Macpaul Lin1cac36e2011-10-19 20:41:11 +00004388 [ARM, NDS32, MIPS only] If this variable is defined, then certain
Wolfgang Denk302141d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01004389 low level initializations (like setting up the memory
4390 controller) are omitted and/or U-Boot does not
4391 relocate itself into RAM.
wdenk3d3d99f2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00004392
Wolfgang Denk302141d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01004393 Normally this variable MUST NOT be defined. The only
4394 exception is when U-Boot is loaded (to RAM) by some
4395 other boot loader or by a debugger which performs
4396 these initializations itself.
wdenk3d3d99f2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00004397
Aneesh V552a3192011-07-13 05:11:07 +00004398- CONFIG_SPL_BUILD
Magnus Lilja1ec96d82009-06-13 20:50:00 +02004399 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
4400 that is executed before the actual U-Boot. E.g. when
4401 compiling a NAND SPL.
wdenk336b2bc2005-04-02 23:52:25 +00004402
Ying Zhang2d2e3b62013-08-16 15:16:15 +08004403- CONFIG_TPL_BUILD
4404 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
4405 that is executed after the SPL and before the actual U-Boot.
4406 It is loaded by the SPL.
4407
Ying Zhang0d4f5442013-05-20 14:07:23 +08004408- CONFIG_SYS_MPC85XX_NO_RESETVEC
4409 Only for 85xx systems. If this variable is specified, the section
4410 .resetvec is not kept and the section .bootpg is placed in the
4411 previous 4k of the .text section.
4412
Simon Glass17dabf02013-02-24 17:33:14 +00004413- CONFIG_ARCH_MAP_SYSMEM
4414 Generally U-Boot (and in particular the md command) uses
4415 effective address. It is therefore not necessary to regard
4416 U-Boot address as virtual addresses that need to be translated
4417 to physical addresses. However, sandbox requires this, since
4418 it maintains its own little RAM buffer which contains all
4419 addressable memory. This option causes some memory accesses
4420 to be mapped through map_sysmem() / unmap_sysmem().
4421
Matthias Weisser93416c12011-03-10 21:36:32 +00004422- CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMCPY
4423 CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMSET
4424 If these options are used a optimized version of memcpy/memset will
4425 be used if available. These functions may be faster under some
4426 conditions but may increase the binary size.
4427
Simon Glassbfb59802013-02-14 04:18:54 +00004428- CONFIG_X86_RESET_VECTOR
4429 If defined, the x86 reset vector code is included. This is not
4430 needed when U-Boot is running from Coreboot.
Gabe Black14f82462012-11-27 21:08:06 +00004431
Mark Jackson52b003c2013-03-04 01:27:20 +00004432- CONFIG_SYS_MPUCLK
4433 Defines the MPU clock speed (in MHz).
4434
4435 NOTE : currently only supported on AM335x platforms.
Gabe Black76ce2492012-11-29 16:23:41 +00004436
Heiko Schocher2233e462013-11-04 14:05:00 +01004437- CONFIG_SPL_AM33XX_ENABLE_RTC32K_OSC:
4438 Enables the RTC32K OSC on AM33xx based plattforms
4439
Timur Tabi275f4bb2011-11-22 09:21:25 -06004440Freescale QE/FMAN Firmware Support:
4441-----------------------------------
4442
4443The Freescale QUICCEngine (QE) and Frame Manager (FMAN) both support the
4444loading of "firmware", which is encoded in the QE firmware binary format.
4445This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting, so macros
4446are used to identify the storage device (NOR flash, SPI, etc) and the address
4447within that device.
4448
4449- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_ADDR
4450 The address in the storage device where the firmware is located. The
4451 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_IN_xxx macro
4452 is also specified.
4453
4454- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_LENGTH
4455 The maximum possible size of the firmware. The firmware binary format
4456 has a field that specifies the actual size of the firmware, but it
4457 might not be possible to read any part of the firmware unless some
4458 local storage is allocated to hold the entire firmware first.
4459
4460- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NOR
4461 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NOR flash, mapped as
4462 normal addressable memory via the LBC. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the
4463 virtual address in NOR flash.
4464
4465- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NAND
4466 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NAND flash.
4467 CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the offset within NAND flash.
4468
4469- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_MMC
4470 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SD/MMC
4471 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
4472
4473- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_SPIFLASH
4474 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SPI
4475 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
4476
Liu Gang1e084582012-03-08 00:33:18 +00004477- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_REMOTE
4478 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in the remote (master)
4479 memory space. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is a virtual address which
Liu Gang357bf5a2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00004480 can be mapped from slave TLB->slave LAW->slave SRIO or PCIE outbound
4481 window->master inbound window->master LAW->the ucode address in
4482 master's memory space.
Timur Tabi275f4bb2011-11-22 09:21:25 -06004483
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004484Building the Software:
4485======================
4486
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004487Building U-Boot has been tested in several native build environments
4488and in many different cross environments. Of course we cannot support
4489all possibly existing versions of cross development tools in all
4490(potentially obsolete) versions. In case of tool chain problems we
4491recommend to use the ELDK (see http://www.denx.de/wiki/DULG/ELDK)
4492which is extensively used to build and test U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004493
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004494If you are not using a native environment, it is assumed that you
4495have GNU cross compiling tools available in your path. In this case,
4496you must set the environment variable CROSS_COMPILE in your shell.
4497Note that no changes to the Makefile or any other source files are
4498necessary. For example using the ELDK on a 4xx CPU, please enter:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004499
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004500 $ CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_4xx-
4501 $ export CROSS_COMPILE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004502
Peter Tyserb06976d2009-03-13 18:54:51 -05004503Note: If you wish to generate Windows versions of the utilities in
4504 the tools directory you can use the MinGW toolchain
4505 (http://www.mingw.org). Set your HOST tools to the MinGW
4506 toolchain and execute 'make tools'. For example:
4507
4508 $ make HOSTCC=i586-mingw32msvc-gcc HOSTSTRIP=i586-mingw32msvc-strip tools
4509
4510 Binaries such as tools/mkimage.exe will be created which can
4511 be executed on computers running Windows.
4512
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004513U-Boot is intended to be simple to build. After installing the
4514sources you must configure U-Boot for one specific board type. This
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004515is done by typing:
4516
4517 make NAME_config
4518
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004519where "NAME_config" is the name of one of the existing configu-
Michael Jones5a7fb6f2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00004520rations; see boards.cfg for supported names.
wdenk2f0812d2003-10-08 22:45:44 +00004521
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004522Note: for some board special configuration names may exist; check if
4523 additional information is available from the board vendor; for
4524 instance, the TQM823L systems are available without (standard)
4525 or with LCD support. You can select such additional "features"
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004526 when choosing the configuration, i. e.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004527
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004528 make TQM823L_config
4529 - will configure for a plain TQM823L, i. e. no LCD support
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004530
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004531 make TQM823L_LCD_config
4532 - will configure for a TQM823L with U-Boot console on LCD
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004533
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004534 etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004535
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004536
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004537Finally, type "make all", and you should get some working U-Boot
4538images ready for download to / installation on your system:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004539
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004540- "u-boot.bin" is a raw binary image
4541- "u-boot" is an image in ELF binary format
4542- "u-boot.srec" is in Motorola S-Record format
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004543
Marian Balakowiczefe063f2006-09-07 17:25:40 +02004544By default the build is performed locally and the objects are saved
4545in the source directory. One of the two methods can be used to change
4546this behavior and build U-Boot to some external directory:
4547
45481. Add O= to the make command line invocations:
4549
4550 make O=/tmp/build distclean
4551 make O=/tmp/build NAME_config
4552 make O=/tmp/build all
4553
45542. Set environment variable BUILD_DIR to point to the desired location:
4555
4556 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
4557 make distclean
4558 make NAME_config
4559 make all
4560
4561Note that the command line "O=" setting overrides the BUILD_DIR environment
4562variable.
4563
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004564
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004565Please be aware that the Makefiles assume you are using GNU make, so
4566for instance on NetBSD you might need to use "gmake" instead of
4567native "make".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004568
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004569
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004570If the system board that you have is not listed, then you will need
4571to port U-Boot to your hardware platform. To do this, follow these
4572steps:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004573
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +000045741. Add a new configuration option for your board to the toplevel
Michael Jones5a7fb6f2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00004575 "boards.cfg" file, using the existing entries as examples.
4576 Follow the instructions there to keep the boards in order.
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +000045772. Create a new directory to hold your board specific code. Add any
4578 files you need. In your board directory, you will need at least
4579 the "Makefile", a "<board>.c", "flash.c" and "u-boot.lds".
45803. Create a new configuration file "include/configs/<board>.h" for
4581 your board
45823. If you're porting U-Boot to a new CPU, then also create a new
4583 directory to hold your CPU specific code. Add any files you need.
45844. Run "make <board>_config" with your new name.
45855. Type "make", and you should get a working "u-boot.srec" file
4586 to be installed on your target system.
45876. Debug and solve any problems that might arise.
4588 [Of course, this last step is much harder than it sounds.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004589
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004590
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004591Testing of U-Boot Modifications, Ports to New Hardware, etc.:
4592==============================================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004593
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004594If you have modified U-Boot sources (for instance added a new board
4595or support for new devices, a new CPU, etc.) you are expected to
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004596provide feedback to the other developers. The feedback normally takes
4597the form of a "patch", i. e. a context diff against a certain (latest
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004598official or latest in the git repository) version of U-Boot sources.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004599
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004600But before you submit such a patch, please verify that your modifi-
4601cation did not break existing code. At least make sure that *ALL* of
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004602the supported boards compile WITHOUT ANY compiler warnings. To do so,
4603just run the "MAKEALL" script, which will configure and build U-Boot
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004604for ALL supported system. Be warned, this will take a while. You can
4605select which (cross) compiler to use by passing a `CROSS_COMPILE'
4606environment variable to the script, i. e. to use the ELDK cross tools
4607you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004608
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004609 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004610
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004611or to build on a native PowerPC system you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004612
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004613 CROSS_COMPILE=' ' MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004614
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004615When using the MAKEALL script, the default behaviour is to build
4616U-Boot in the source directory. This location can be changed by
4617setting the BUILD_DIR environment variable. Also, for each target
4618built, the MAKEALL script saves two log files (<target>.ERR and
4619<target>.MAKEALL) in the <source dir>/LOG directory. This default
4620location can be changed by setting the MAKEALL_LOGDIR environment
4621variable. For example:
Marian Balakowiczefe063f2006-09-07 17:25:40 +02004622
4623 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
4624 export MAKEALL_LOGDIR=/tmp/log
4625 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
4626
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004627With the above settings build objects are saved in the /tmp/build,
4628log files are saved in the /tmp/log and the source tree remains clean
4629during the whole build process.
Marian Balakowiczefe063f2006-09-07 17:25:40 +02004630
4631
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004632See also "U-Boot Porting Guide" below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004633
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004634
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004635Monitor Commands - Overview:
4636============================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004637
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004638go - start application at address 'addr'
4639run - run commands in an environment variable
4640bootm - boot application image from memory
4641bootp - boot image via network using BootP/TFTP protocol
Marek Vasutcf41a9b2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00004642bootz - boot zImage from memory
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004643tftpboot- boot image via network using TFTP protocol
4644 and env variables "ipaddr" and "serverip"
4645 (and eventually "gatewayip")
Simon Glass6a398d22011-10-24 18:00:07 +00004646tftpput - upload a file via network using TFTP protocol
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004647rarpboot- boot image via network using RARP/TFTP protocol
4648diskboot- boot from IDE devicebootd - boot default, i.e., run 'bootcmd'
4649loads - load S-Record file over serial line
4650loadb - load binary file over serial line (kermit mode)
4651md - memory display
4652mm - memory modify (auto-incrementing)
4653nm - memory modify (constant address)
4654mw - memory write (fill)
4655cp - memory copy
4656cmp - memory compare
4657crc32 - checksum calculation
Peter Tyser469cde42009-04-18 22:34:03 -05004658i2c - I2C sub-system
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004659sspi - SPI utility commands
4660base - print or set address offset
4661printenv- print environment variables
4662setenv - set environment variables
4663saveenv - save environment variables to persistent storage
4664protect - enable or disable FLASH write protection
4665erase - erase FLASH memory
4666flinfo - print FLASH memory information
Karl O. Pinc4baf03d2012-08-03 05:57:21 +00004667nand - NAND memory operations (see doc/README.nand)
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004668bdinfo - print Board Info structure
4669iminfo - print header information for application image
4670coninfo - print console devices and informations
4671ide - IDE sub-system
4672loop - infinite loop on address range
wdenk64519362004-07-11 17:40:54 +00004673loopw - infinite write loop on address range
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004674mtest - simple RAM test
4675icache - enable or disable instruction cache
4676dcache - enable or disable data cache
4677reset - Perform RESET of the CPU
4678echo - echo args to console
4679version - print monitor version
4680help - print online help
4681? - alias for 'help'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004682
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004683
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004684Monitor Commands - Detailed Description:
4685========================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004686
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004687TODO.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004688
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004689For now: just type "help <command>".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004690
4691
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004692Environment Variables:
4693======================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004694
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004695U-Boot supports user configuration using Environment Variables which
4696can be made persistent by saving to Flash memory.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004697
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004698Environment Variables are set using "setenv", printed using
4699"printenv", and saved to Flash using "saveenv". Using "setenv"
4700without a value can be used to delete a variable from the
4701environment. As long as you don't save the environment you are
4702working with an in-memory copy. In case the Flash area containing the
4703environment is erased by accident, a default environment is provided.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004704
Wolfgang Denkb233bd72010-01-17 23:55:53 +01004705Some configuration options can be set using Environment Variables.
4706
4707List of environment variables (most likely not complete):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004708
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004709 baudrate - see CONFIG_BAUDRATE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004710
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004711 bootdelay - see CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004712
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004713 bootcmd - see CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004714
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004715 bootargs - Boot arguments when booting an RTOS image
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004716
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004717 bootfile - Name of the image to load with TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004718
Bartlomiej Siekac5648c82008-04-14 15:44:16 +02004719 bootm_low - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
4720 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
4721 a hexadecimal number and defines lowest address allowed
4722 for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_size"
4723 environment variable. Address defined by "bootm_low" is
4724 also the base of the initial memory mapping for the Linux
Grant Likely26396382011-03-28 09:58:43 +00004725 kernel -- see the description of CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ and
4726 bootm_mapsize.
4727
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004728 bootm_mapsize - Size of the initial memory mapping for the Linux kernel.
Grant Likely26396382011-03-28 09:58:43 +00004729 This variable is given as a hexadecimal number and it
4730 defines the size of the memory region starting at base
4731 address bootm_low that is accessible by the Linux kernel
4732 during early boot. If unset, CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is used
4733 as the default value if it is defined, and bootm_size is
4734 used otherwise.
Bartlomiej Siekac5648c82008-04-14 15:44:16 +02004735
4736 bootm_size - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
4737 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
4738 a hexadecimal number and defines the size of the region
4739 allowed for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_low"
4740 environment variable.
4741
Bartlomiej Siekae273e9f2008-10-01 15:26:31 +02004742 updatefile - Location of the software update file on a TFTP server, used
4743 by the automatic software update feature. Please refer to
4744 documentation in doc/README.update for more details.
4745
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004746 autoload - if set to "no" (any string beginning with 'n'),
4747 "bootp" will just load perform a lookup of the
4748 configuration from the BOOTP server, but not try to
4749 load any image using TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004750
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004751 autostart - if set to "yes", an image loaded using the "bootp",
4752 "rarpboot", "tftpboot" or "diskboot" commands will
4753 be automatically started (by internally calling
4754 "bootm")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004755
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004756 If set to "no", a standalone image passed to the
4757 "bootm" command will be copied to the load address
4758 (and eventually uncompressed), but NOT be started.
4759 This can be used to load and uncompress arbitrary
4760 data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004761
David A. Longd558a4e2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04004762 fdt_high - if set this restricts the maximum address that the
4763 flattened device tree will be copied into upon boot.
Shawn Guo0ca9e982012-01-09 21:54:08 +00004764 For example, if you have a system with 1 GB memory
4765 at physical address 0x10000000, while Linux kernel
4766 only recognizes the first 704 MB as low memory, you
4767 may need to set fdt_high as 0x3C000000 to have the
4768 device tree blob be copied to the maximum address
4769 of the 704 MB low memory, so that Linux kernel can
4770 access it during the boot procedure.
4771
David A. Longd558a4e2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04004772 If this is set to the special value 0xFFFFFFFF then
4773 the fdt will not be copied at all on boot. For this
4774 to work it must reside in writable memory, have
4775 sufficient padding on the end of it for u-boot to
4776 add the information it needs into it, and the memory
4777 must be accessible by the kernel.
4778
Simon Glassdc6fa642011-10-24 19:15:34 +00004779 fdtcontroladdr- if set this is the address of the control flattened
4780 device tree used by U-Boot when CONFIG_OF_CONTROL is
4781 defined.
4782
wdenk0e2bd9c2004-06-06 21:51:03 +00004783 i2cfast - (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
4784 if set to 'y' configures Linux I2C driver for fast
4785 mode (400kHZ). This environment variable is used in
4786 initialization code. So, for changes to be effective
4787 it must be saved and board must be reset.
4788
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004789 initrd_high - restrict positioning of initrd images:
4790 If this variable is not set, initrd images will be
4791 copied to the highest possible address in RAM; this
4792 is usually what you want since it allows for
4793 maximum initrd size. If for some reason you want to
4794 make sure that the initrd image is loaded below the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004795 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ limit, you can set this environment
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004796 variable to a value of "no" or "off" or "0".
4797 Alternatively, you can set it to a maximum upper
4798 address to use (U-Boot will still check that it
4799 does not overwrite the U-Boot stack and data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004800
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004801 For instance, when you have a system with 16 MB
4802 RAM, and want to reserve 4 MB from use by Linux,
4803 you can do this by adding "mem=12M" to the value of
4804 the "bootargs" variable. However, now you must make
4805 sure that the initrd image is placed in the first
4806 12 MB as well - this can be done with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004807
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004808 setenv initrd_high 00c00000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004809
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004810 If you set initrd_high to 0xFFFFFFFF, this is an
4811 indication to U-Boot that all addresses are legal
4812 for the Linux kernel, including addresses in flash
4813 memory. In this case U-Boot will NOT COPY the
4814 ramdisk at all. This may be useful to reduce the
4815 boot time on your system, but requires that this
4816 feature is supported by your Linux kernel.
wdenk3f9ab982003-04-12 23:38:12 +00004817
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004818 ipaddr - IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004819
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004820 loadaddr - Default load address for commands like "bootp",
4821 "rarpboot", "tftpboot", "loadb" or "diskboot"
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004822
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004823 loads_echo - see CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004824
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004825 serverip - TFTP server IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenk6f770ed2003-05-23 23:18:21 +00004826
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004827 bootretry - see CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004828
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004829 bootdelaykey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004830
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004831 bootstopkey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004832
Mike Frysingera23230c2011-10-02 10:01:27 +00004833 ethprime - controls which interface is used first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004834
Mike Frysingera23230c2011-10-02 10:01:27 +00004835 ethact - controls which interface is currently active.
4836 For example you can do the following
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004837
Heiko Schocherc5e84052010-07-20 17:45:02 +02004838 => setenv ethact FEC
4839 => ping 192.168.0.1 # traffic sent on FEC
4840 => setenv ethact SCC
4841 => ping 10.0.0.1 # traffic sent on SCC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004842
Matthias Fuchs204f0ec2008-01-17 07:45:05 +01004843 ethrotate - When set to "no" U-Boot does not go through all
4844 available network interfaces.
4845 It just stays at the currently selected interface.
4846
Wolfgang Denkb233bd72010-01-17 23:55:53 +01004847 netretry - When set to "no" each network operation will
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004848 either succeed or fail without retrying.
4849 When set to "once" the network operation will
4850 fail when all the available network interfaces
4851 are tried once without success.
4852 Useful on scripts which control the retry operation
4853 themselves.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004854
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD1948d6c2009-01-31 09:53:39 +01004855 npe_ucode - set load address for the NPE microcode
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDd2164ef2008-01-07 08:41:34 +01004856
Simon Glass5db3f932013-07-16 20:10:00 -07004857 silent_linux - If set then linux will be told to boot silently, by
4858 changing the console to be empty. If "yes" it will be
4859 made silent. If "no" it will not be made silent. If
4860 unset, then it will be made silent if the U-Boot console
4861 is silent.
4862
Wolfgang Denk227b5192005-09-24 23:25:46 +02004863 tftpsrcport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's
Wolfgang Denke3cfce52005-09-24 22:37:32 +02004864 UDP source port.
4865
Wolfgang Denk227b5192005-09-24 23:25:46 +02004866 tftpdstport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's UDP
4867 destination port instead of the Well Know Port 69.
4868
Wolfgang Denkb233bd72010-01-17 23:55:53 +01004869 tftpblocksize - Block size to use for TFTP transfers; if not set,
4870 we use the TFTP server's default block size
4871
4872 tftptimeout - Retransmission timeout for TFTP packets (in milli-
4873 seconds, minimum value is 1000 = 1 second). Defines
4874 when a packet is considered to be lost so it has to
4875 be retransmitted. The default is 5000 = 5 seconds.
4876 Lowering this value may make downloads succeed
4877 faster in networks with high packet loss rates or
4878 with unreliable TFTP servers.
4879
4880 vlan - When set to a value < 4095 the traffic over
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004881 Ethernet is encapsulated/received over 802.1q
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004882 VLAN tagged frames.
wdenk145d2c12004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004883
Jason Hobbse3fe08e2011-08-31 05:37:28 +00004884The following image location variables contain the location of images
4885used in booting. The "Image" column gives the role of the image and is
4886not an environment variable name. The other columns are environment
4887variable names. "File Name" gives the name of the file on a TFTP
4888server, "RAM Address" gives the location in RAM the image will be
4889loaded to, and "Flash Location" gives the image's address in NOR
4890flash or offset in NAND flash.
4891
4892*Note* - these variables don't have to be defined for all boards, some
4893boards currenlty use other variables for these purposes, and some
4894boards use these variables for other purposes.
4895
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004896Image File Name RAM Address Flash Location
4897----- --------- ----------- --------------
4898u-boot u-boot u-boot_addr_r u-boot_addr
4899Linux kernel bootfile kernel_addr_r kernel_addr
4900device tree blob fdtfile fdt_addr_r fdt_addr
4901ramdisk ramdiskfile ramdisk_addr_r ramdisk_addr
Jason Hobbse3fe08e2011-08-31 05:37:28 +00004902
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004903The following environment variables may be used and automatically
4904updated by the network boot commands ("bootp" and "rarpboot"),
4905depending the information provided by your boot server:
wdenk145d2c12004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004906
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004907 bootfile - see above
4908 dnsip - IP address of your Domain Name Server
4909 dnsip2 - IP address of your secondary Domain Name Server
4910 gatewayip - IP address of the Gateway (Router) to use
4911 hostname - Target hostname
4912 ipaddr - see above
4913 netmask - Subnet Mask
4914 rootpath - Pathname of the root filesystem on the NFS server
4915 serverip - see above
wdenk145d2c12004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004916
wdenk145d2c12004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004917
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004918There are two special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004919
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004920 serial# - contains hardware identification information such
4921 as type string and/or serial number
4922 ethaddr - Ethernet address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004923
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004924These variables can be set only once (usually during manufacturing of
4925the board). U-Boot refuses to delete or overwrite these variables
4926once they have been set once.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004927
4928
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004929Further special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004930
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004931 ver - Contains the U-Boot version string as printed
4932 with the "version" command. This variable is
4933 readonly (see CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004934
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004935
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004936Please note that changes to some configuration parameters may take
4937only effect after the next boot (yes, that's just like Windoze :-).
stroeseb9c17c52003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004938
stroeseb9c17c52003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004939
Joe Hershberger60fd3ad2012-12-11 22:16:24 -06004940Callback functions for environment variables:
4941---------------------------------------------
4942
4943For some environment variables, the behavior of u-boot needs to change
4944when their values are changed. This functionailty allows functions to
4945be associated with arbitrary variables. On creation, overwrite, or
4946deletion, the callback will provide the opportunity for some side
4947effect to happen or for the change to be rejected.
4948
4949The callbacks are named and associated with a function using the
4950U_BOOT_ENV_CALLBACK macro in your board or driver code.
4951
4952These callbacks are associated with variables in one of two ways. The
4953static list can be added to by defining CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_STATIC
4954in the board configuration to a string that defines a list of
4955associations. The list must be in the following format:
4956
4957 entry = variable_name[:callback_name]
4958 list = entry[,list]
4959
4960If the callback name is not specified, then the callback is deleted.
4961Spaces are also allowed anywhere in the list.
4962
4963Callbacks can also be associated by defining the ".callbacks" variable
4964with the same list format above. Any association in ".callbacks" will
4965override any association in the static list. You can define
4966CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_DEFAULT to a list (string) to define the
4967".callbacks" envirnoment variable in the default or embedded environment.
4968
4969
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004970Command Line Parsing:
4971=====================
stroeseb9c17c52003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004972
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004973There are two different command line parsers available with U-Boot:
4974the old "simple" one, and the much more powerful "hush" shell:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004975
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004976Old, simple command line parser:
4977--------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004978
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004979- supports environment variables (through setenv / saveenv commands)
4980- several commands on one line, separated by ';'
Wolfgang Denk86eb3b72005-11-20 21:40:11 +01004981- variable substitution using "... ${name} ..." syntax
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004982- special characters ('$', ';') can be escaped by prefixing with '\',
4983 for example:
Wolfgang Denk86eb3b72005-11-20 21:40:11 +01004984 setenv bootcmd bootm \${address}
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004985- You can also escape text by enclosing in single apostrophes, for example:
4986 setenv addip 'setenv bootargs $bootargs ip=$ipaddr:$serverip:$gatewayip:$netmask:$hostname::off'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004987
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004988Hush shell:
4989-----------
wdenkf4688a22003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004990
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004991- similar to Bourne shell, with control structures like
4992 if...then...else...fi, for...do...done; while...do...done,
4993 until...do...done, ...
4994- supports environment ("global") variables (through setenv / saveenv
4995 commands) and local shell variables (through standard shell syntax
4996 "name=value"); only environment variables can be used with "run"
4997 command
wdenkf4688a22003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004998
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004999General rules:
5000--------------
wdenkf4688a22003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005001
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005002(1) If a command line (or an environment variable executed by a "run"
5003 command) contains several commands separated by semicolon, and
5004 one of these commands fails, then the remaining commands will be
5005 executed anyway.
wdenkf4688a22003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005006
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005007(2) If you execute several variables with one call to run (i. e.
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005008 calling run with a list of variables as arguments), any failing
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005009 command will cause "run" to terminate, i. e. the remaining
5010 variables are not executed.
wdenkf4688a22003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005011
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005012Note for Redundant Ethernet Interfaces:
5013=======================================
wdenkf4688a22003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005014
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005015Some boards come with redundant Ethernet interfaces; U-Boot supports
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005016such configurations and is capable of automatic selection of a
5017"working" interface when needed. MAC assignment works as follows:
wdenkf4688a22003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005018
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005019Network interfaces are numbered eth0, eth1, eth2, ... Corresponding
5020MAC addresses can be stored in the environment as "ethaddr" (=>eth0),
5021"eth1addr" (=>eth1), "eth2addr", ...
wdenkf4688a22003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005022
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005023If the network interface stores some valid MAC address (for instance
5024in SROM), this is used as default address if there is NO correspon-
5025ding setting in the environment; if the corresponding environment
5026variable is set, this overrides the settings in the card; that means:
wdenkf4688a22003-05-28 08:06:31 +00005027
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005028o If the SROM has a valid MAC address, and there is no address in the
5029 environment, the SROM's address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005030
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005031o If there is no valid address in the SROM, and a definition in the
5032 environment exists, then the value from the environment variable is
5033 used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005034
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005035o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and
5036 both addresses are the same, this MAC address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005037
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005038o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and the
5039 addresses differ, the value from the environment is used and a
5040 warning is printed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005041
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005042o If neither SROM nor the environment contain a MAC address, an error
5043 is raised.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005044
Ben Warren6db991a2010-04-26 11:11:46 -07005045If Ethernet drivers implement the 'write_hwaddr' function, valid MAC addresses
Wolfgang Denk092ae952011-10-26 10:21:21 +00005046will be programmed into hardware as part of the initialization process. This
Ben Warren6db991a2010-04-26 11:11:46 -07005047may be skipped by setting the appropriate 'ethmacskip' environment variable.
5048The naming convention is as follows:
5049"ethmacskip" (=>eth0), "eth1macskip" (=>eth1) etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005050
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005051Image Formats:
5052==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005053
Marian Balakowicz18710b82008-03-12 12:13:13 +01005054U-Boot is capable of booting (and performing other auxiliary operations on)
5055images in two formats:
5056
5057New uImage format (FIT)
5058-----------------------
5059
5060Flexible and powerful format based on Flattened Image Tree -- FIT (similar
5061to Flattened Device Tree). It allows the use of images with multiple
5062components (several kernels, ramdisks, etc.), with contents protected by
5063SHA1, MD5 or CRC32. More details are found in the doc/uImage.FIT directory.
5064
5065
5066Old uImage format
5067-----------------
5068
5069Old image format is based on binary files which can be basically anything,
5070preceded by a special header; see the definitions in include/image.h for
5071details; basically, the header defines the following image properties:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005072
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005073* Target Operating System (Provisions for OpenBSD, NetBSD, FreeBSD,
5074 4.4BSD, Linux, SVR4, Esix, Solaris, Irix, SCO, Dell, NCR, VxWorks,
Peter Tyser56b8dd12008-09-08 14:56:49 -05005075 LynxOS, pSOS, QNX, RTEMS, INTEGRITY;
5076 Currently supported: Linux, NetBSD, VxWorks, QNX, RTEMS, LynxOS,
5077 INTEGRITY).
Wolfgang Denk83c15852006-10-24 14:21:16 +02005078* Target CPU Architecture (Provisions for Alpha, ARM, AVR32, Intel x86,
Macpaul Lin1cac36e2011-10-19 20:41:11 +00005079 IA64, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC, IBM S390, SuperH, Sparc, Sparc 64 Bit;
5080 Currently supported: ARM, AVR32, Intel x86, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC).
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005081* Compression Type (uncompressed, gzip, bzip2)
5082* Load Address
5083* Entry Point
5084* Image Name
5085* Image Timestamp
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005086
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005087The header is marked by a special Magic Number, and both the header
5088and the data portions of the image are secured against corruption by
5089CRC32 checksums.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005090
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005091
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005092Linux Support:
5093==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005094
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005095Although U-Boot should support any OS or standalone application
5096easily, the main focus has always been on Linux during the design of
5097U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005098
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005099U-Boot includes many features that so far have been part of some
5100special "boot loader" code within the Linux kernel. Also, any
5101"initrd" images to be used are no longer part of one big Linux image;
5102instead, kernel and "initrd" are separate images. This implementation
5103serves several purposes:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005104
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005105- the same features can be used for other OS or standalone
5106 applications (for instance: using compressed images to reduce the
5107 Flash memory footprint)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005108
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005109- it becomes much easier to port new Linux kernel versions because
5110 lots of low-level, hardware dependent stuff are done by U-Boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005111
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005112- the same Linux kernel image can now be used with different "initrd"
5113 images; of course this also means that different kernel images can
5114 be run with the same "initrd". This makes testing easier (you don't
5115 have to build a new "zImage.initrd" Linux image when you just
5116 change a file in your "initrd"). Also, a field-upgrade of the
5117 software is easier now.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005118
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005119
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005120Linux HOWTO:
5121============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005122
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005123Porting Linux to U-Boot based systems:
5124---------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005125
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005126U-Boot cannot save you from doing all the necessary modifications to
5127configure the Linux device drivers for use with your target hardware
5128(no, we don't intend to provide a full virtual machine interface to
5129Linux :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005130
Stefan Roese88fbf932010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005131But now you can ignore ALL boot loader code (in arch/powerpc/mbxboot).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005132
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005133Just make sure your machine specific header file (for instance
5134include/asm-ppc/tqm8xx.h) includes the same definition of the Board
Markus Heidelberg47167572008-09-07 20:18:27 +02005135Information structure as we define in include/asm-<arch>/u-boot.h,
5136and make sure that your definition of IMAP_ADDR uses the same value
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02005137as your U-Boot configuration in CONFIG_SYS_IMMR.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005138
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005139
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005140Configuring the Linux kernel:
5141-----------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005142
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005143No specific requirements for U-Boot. Make sure you have some root
5144device (initial ramdisk, NFS) for your target system.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005145
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005146
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005147Building a Linux Image:
5148-----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005149
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005150With U-Boot, "normal" build targets like "zImage" or "bzImage" are
5151not used. If you use recent kernel source, a new build target
5152"uImage" will exist which automatically builds an image usable by
5153U-Boot. Most older kernels also have support for a "pImage" target,
5154which was introduced for our predecessor project PPCBoot and uses a
5155100% compatible format.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005156
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005157Example:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005158
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005159 make TQM850L_config
5160 make oldconfig
5161 make dep
5162 make uImage
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005163
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005164The "uImage" build target uses a special tool (in 'tools/mkimage') to
5165encapsulate a compressed Linux kernel image with header information,
5166CRC32 checksum etc. for use with U-Boot. This is what we are doing:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005167
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005168* build a standard "vmlinux" kernel image (in ELF binary format):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005169
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005170* convert the kernel into a raw binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005171
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005172 ${CROSS_COMPILE}-objcopy -O binary \
5173 -R .note -R .comment \
5174 -S vmlinux linux.bin
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005175
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005176* compress the binary image:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005177
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005178 gzip -9 linux.bin
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005179
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005180* package compressed binary image for U-Boot:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005181
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005182 mkimage -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip \
5183 -a 0 -e 0 -n "Linux Kernel Image" \
5184 -d linux.bin.gz uImage
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005185
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005186
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005187The "mkimage" tool can also be used to create ramdisk images for use
5188with U-Boot, either separated from the Linux kernel image, or
5189combined into one file. "mkimage" encapsulates the images with a 64
5190byte header containing information about target architecture,
5191operating system, image type, compression method, entry points, time
5192stamp, CRC32 checksums, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005193
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005194"mkimage" can be called in two ways: to verify existing images and
5195print the header information, or to build new images.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005196
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005197In the first form (with "-l" option) mkimage lists the information
5198contained in the header of an existing U-Boot image; this includes
5199checksum verification:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005200
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005201 tools/mkimage -l image
5202 -l ==> list image header information
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005203
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005204The second form (with "-d" option) is used to build a U-Boot image
5205from a "data file" which is used as image payload:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005206
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005207 tools/mkimage -A arch -O os -T type -C comp -a addr -e ep \
5208 -n name -d data_file image
5209 -A ==> set architecture to 'arch'
5210 -O ==> set operating system to 'os'
5211 -T ==> set image type to 'type'
5212 -C ==> set compression type 'comp'
5213 -a ==> set load address to 'addr' (hex)
5214 -e ==> set entry point to 'ep' (hex)
5215 -n ==> set image name to 'name'
5216 -d ==> use image data from 'datafile'
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00005217
wdenkcd914452004-05-29 16:53:29 +00005218Right now, all Linux kernels for PowerPC systems use the same load
5219address (0x00000000), but the entry point address depends on the
5220kernel version:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005221
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005222- 2.2.x kernels have the entry point at 0x0000000C,
5223- 2.3.x and later kernels have the entry point at 0x00000000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005224
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005225So a typical call to build a U-Boot image would read:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005226
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005227 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
5228 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roese88fbf932010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005229 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz \
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005230 > examples/uImage.TQM850L
5231 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
5232 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
5233 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5234 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
5235 Load Address: 0x00000000
5236 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005237
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005238To verify the contents of the image (or check for corruption):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005239
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005240 -> tools/mkimage -l examples/uImage.TQM850L
5241 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
5242 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
5243 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5244 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
5245 Load Address: 0x00000000
5246 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005247
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005248NOTE: for embedded systems where boot time is critical you can trade
5249speed for memory and install an UNCOMPRESSED image instead: this
5250needs more space in Flash, but boots much faster since it does not
5251need to be uncompressed:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005252
Stefan Roese88fbf932010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005253 -> gunzip /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005254 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
5255 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C none -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roese88fbf932010-04-15 16:07:28 +02005256 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux \
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005257 > examples/uImage.TQM850L-uncompressed
5258 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
5259 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
5260 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (uncompressed)
5261 Data Size: 792160 Bytes = 773.59 kB = 0.76 MB
5262 Load Address: 0x00000000
5263 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005264
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005265
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005266Similar you can build U-Boot images from a 'ramdisk.image.gz' file
5267when your kernel is intended to use an initial ramdisk:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005268
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005269 -> tools/mkimage -n 'Simple Ramdisk Image' \
5270 > -A ppc -O linux -T ramdisk -C gzip \
5271 > -d /LinuxPPC/images/SIMPLE-ramdisk.image.gz examples/simple-initrd
5272 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
5273 Created: Wed Jan 12 14:01:50 2000
5274 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
5275 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553.25 kB = 0.54 MB
5276 Load Address: 0x00000000
5277 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005278
Guilherme Maciel Ferreira51553812013-12-01 12:43:11 -07005279The "dumpimage" is a tool to disassemble images built by mkimage. Its "-i"
5280option performs the converse operation of the mkimage's second form (the "-d"
5281option). Given an image built by mkimage, the dumpimage extracts a "data file"
5282from the image:
5283
5284 tools/dumpimage -i image -p position data_file
5285 -i ==> extract from the 'image' a specific 'data_file', \
5286 indexed by 'position'
5287
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005288
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005289Installing a Linux Image:
5290-------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005291
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005292To downloading a U-Boot image over the serial (console) interface,
5293you must convert the image to S-Record format:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005294
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005295 objcopy -I binary -O srec examples/image examples/image.srec
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005296
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005297The 'objcopy' does not understand the information in the U-Boot
5298image header, so the resulting S-Record file will be relative to
5299address 0x00000000. To load it to a given address, you need to
5300specify the target address as 'offset' parameter with the 'loads'
5301command.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005302
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005303Example: install the image to address 0x40100000 (which on the
5304TQM8xxL is in the first Flash bank):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005305
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005306 => erase 40100000 401FFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005307
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005308 .......... done
5309 Erased 8 sectors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005310
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005311 => loads 40100000
5312 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
5313 ~>examples/image.srec
5314 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 ...
5315 ...
5316 15989 15990 15991 15992
5317 [file transfer complete]
5318 [connected]
5319 ## Start Addr = 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005320
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005321
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005322You can check the success of the download using the 'iminfo' command;
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005323this includes a checksum verification so you can be sure no data
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005324corruption happened:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005325
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005326 => imi 40100000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005327
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005328 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
5329 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
5330 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5331 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
5332 Load Address: 00000000
5333 Entry Point: 0000000c
5334 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005335
5336
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005337Boot Linux:
5338-----------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005339
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005340The "bootm" command is used to boot an application that is stored in
5341memory (RAM or Flash). In case of a Linux kernel image, the contents
5342of the "bootargs" environment variable is passed to the kernel as
5343parameters. You can check and modify this variable using the
5344"printenv" and "setenv" commands:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005345
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005346
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005347 => printenv bootargs
5348 bootargs=root=/dev/ram
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005349
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005350 => setenv bootargs root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005351
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005352 => printenv bootargs
5353 bootargs=root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005354
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005355 => bootm 40020000
5356 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40020000 ...
5357 Image Name: 2.2.13 for NFS on TQM850L
5358 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5359 Data Size: 381681 Bytes = 372 kB = 0 MB
5360 Load Address: 00000000
5361 Entry Point: 0000000c
5362 Verifying Checksum ... OK
5363 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
5364 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:35:17 MEST 2000
5365 Boot arguments: root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
5366 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
5367 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
5368 Memory: 15208k available (700k kernel code, 444k data, 32k init) [c0000000,c1000000]
5369 ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005370
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005371If you want to boot a Linux kernel with initial RAM disk, you pass
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005372the memory addresses of both the kernel and the initrd image (PPBCOOT
5373format!) to the "bootm" command:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005374
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005375 => imi 40100000 40200000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005376
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005377 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
5378 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
5379 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5380 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
5381 Load Address: 00000000
5382 Entry Point: 0000000c
5383 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005384
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005385 ## Checking Image at 40200000 ...
5386 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
5387 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
5388 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
5389 Load Address: 00000000
5390 Entry Point: 00000000
5391 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005392
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005393 => bootm 40100000 40200000
5394 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40100000 ...
5395 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
5396 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5397 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
5398 Load Address: 00000000
5399 Entry Point: 0000000c
5400 Verifying Checksum ... OK
5401 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
5402 ## Loading RAMDisk Image at 40200000 ...
5403 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
5404 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
5405 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
5406 Load Address: 00000000
5407 Entry Point: 00000000
5408 Verifying Checksum ... OK
5409 Loading Ramdisk ... OK
5410 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:32:08 MEST 2000
5411 Boot arguments: root=/dev/ram
5412 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
5413 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
5414 ...
5415 RAMDISK: Compressed image found at block 0
5416 VFS: Mounted root (ext2 filesystem).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005417
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005418 bash#
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005419
Matthew McClintockefae4ca2006-06-28 10:41:37 -05005420Boot Linux and pass a flat device tree:
5421-----------
5422
5423First, U-Boot must be compiled with the appropriate defines. See the section
5424titled "Linux Kernel Interface" above for a more in depth explanation. The
5425following is an example of how to start a kernel and pass an updated
5426flat device tree:
5427
5428=> print oftaddr
5429oftaddr=0x300000
5430=> print oft
5431oft=oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb
5432=> tftp $oftaddr $oft
5433Speed: 1000, full duplex
5434Using TSEC0 device
5435TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.101
5436Filename 'oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb'.
5437Load address: 0x300000
5438Loading: #
5439done
5440Bytes transferred = 4106 (100a hex)
5441=> tftp $loadaddr $bootfile
5442Speed: 1000, full duplex
5443Using TSEC0 device
5444TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.2
5445Filename 'uImage'.
5446Load address: 0x200000
5447Loading:############
5448done
5449Bytes transferred = 1029407 (fb51f hex)
5450=> print loadaddr
5451loadaddr=200000
5452=> print oftaddr
5453oftaddr=0x300000
5454=> bootm $loadaddr - $oftaddr
5455## Booting image at 00200000 ...
Wolfgang Denk018147d2006-11-27 15:32:42 +01005456 Image Name: Linux-2.6.17-dirty
5457 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
5458 Data Size: 1029343 Bytes = 1005.2 kB
Matthew McClintockefae4ca2006-06-28 10:41:37 -05005459 Load Address: 00000000
Wolfgang Denk018147d2006-11-27 15:32:42 +01005460 Entry Point: 00000000
Matthew McClintockefae4ca2006-06-28 10:41:37 -05005461 Verifying Checksum ... OK
5462 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
5463Booting using flat device tree at 0x300000
5464Using MPC85xx ADS machine description
5465Memory CAM mapping: CAM0=256Mb, CAM1=256Mb, CAM2=0Mb residual: 0Mb
5466[snip]
5467
5468
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005469More About U-Boot Image Types:
5470------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005471
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005472U-Boot supports the following image types:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005473
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005474 "Standalone Programs" are directly runnable in the environment
5475 provided by U-Boot; it is expected that (if they behave
5476 well) you can continue to work in U-Boot after return from
5477 the Standalone Program.
5478 "OS Kernel Images" are usually images of some Embedded OS which
5479 will take over control completely. Usually these programs
5480 will install their own set of exception handlers, device
5481 drivers, set up the MMU, etc. - this means, that you cannot
5482 expect to re-enter U-Boot except by resetting the CPU.
5483 "RAMDisk Images" are more or less just data blocks, and their
5484 parameters (address, size) are passed to an OS kernel that is
5485 being started.
5486 "Multi-File Images" contain several images, typically an OS
5487 (Linux) kernel image and one or more data images like
5488 RAMDisks. This construct is useful for instance when you want
5489 to boot over the network using BOOTP etc., where the boot
5490 server provides just a single image file, but you want to get
5491 for instance an OS kernel and a RAMDisk image.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005492
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005493 "Multi-File Images" start with a list of image sizes, each
5494 image size (in bytes) specified by an "uint32_t" in network
5495 byte order. This list is terminated by an "(uint32_t)0".
5496 Immediately after the terminating 0 follow the images, one by
5497 one, all aligned on "uint32_t" boundaries (size rounded up to
5498 a multiple of 4 bytes).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005499
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005500 "Firmware Images" are binary images containing firmware (like
5501 U-Boot or FPGA images) which usually will be programmed to
5502 flash memory.
wdenk4fc95692003-02-28 00:49:47 +00005503
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005504 "Script files" are command sequences that will be executed by
5505 U-Boot's command interpreter; this feature is especially
5506 useful when you configure U-Boot to use a real shell (hush)
5507 as command interpreter.
wdenk4fc95692003-02-28 00:49:47 +00005508
Marek Vasutcf41a9b2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00005509Booting the Linux zImage:
5510-------------------------
5511
5512On some platforms, it's possible to boot Linux zImage. This is done
5513using the "bootz" command. The syntax of "bootz" command is the same
5514as the syntax of "bootm" command.
5515
Tom Rini45f46d12013-05-16 11:40:11 -04005516Note, defining the CONFIG_SUPPORT_RAW_INITRD allows user to supply
Marek Vasut28850d02012-03-18 11:47:58 +00005517kernel with raw initrd images. The syntax is slightly different, the
5518address of the initrd must be augmented by it's size, in the following
5519format: "<initrd addres>:<initrd size>".
5520
stroeseb9c17c52003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005521
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005522Standalone HOWTO:
5523=================
stroeseb9c17c52003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005524
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005525One of the features of U-Boot is that you can dynamically load and
5526run "standalone" applications, which can use some resources of
5527U-Boot like console I/O functions or interrupt services.
stroeseb9c17c52003-04-04 15:53:41 +00005528
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005529Two simple examples are included with the sources:
wdenk4fc95692003-02-28 00:49:47 +00005530
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005531"Hello World" Demo:
5532-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005533
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005534'examples/hello_world.c' contains a small "Hello World" Demo
5535application; it is automatically compiled when you build U-Boot.
5536It's configured to run at address 0x00040004, so you can play with it
5537like that:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005538
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005539 => loads
5540 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
5541 ~>examples/hello_world.srec
5542 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
5543 [file transfer complete]
5544 [connected]
5545 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005546
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005547 => go 40004 Hello World! This is a test.
5548 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
5549 Hello World
5550 argc = 7
5551 argv[0] = "40004"
5552 argv[1] = "Hello"
5553 argv[2] = "World!"
5554 argv[3] = "This"
5555 argv[4] = "is"
5556 argv[5] = "a"
5557 argv[6] = "test."
5558 argv[7] = "<NULL>"
5559 Hit any key to exit ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005560
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005561 ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005562
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005563Another example, which demonstrates how to register a CPM interrupt
5564handler with the U-Boot code, can be found in 'examples/timer.c'.
5565Here, a CPM timer is set up to generate an interrupt every second.
5566The interrupt service routine is trivial, just printing a '.'
5567character, but this is just a demo program. The application can be
5568controlled by the following keys:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005569
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005570 ? - print current values og the CPM Timer registers
5571 b - enable interrupts and start timer
5572 e - stop timer and disable interrupts
5573 q - quit application
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005574
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005575 => loads
5576 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
5577 ~>examples/timer.srec
5578 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
5579 [file transfer complete]
5580 [connected]
5581 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005582
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005583 => go 40004
5584 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
5585 TIMERS=0xfff00980
5586 Using timer 1
5587 tgcr @ 0xfff00980, tmr @ 0xfff00990, trr @ 0xfff00994, tcr @ 0xfff00998, tcn @ 0xfff0099c, ter @ 0xfff009b0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005588
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005589Hit 'b':
5590 [q, b, e, ?] Set interval 1000000 us
5591 Enabling timer
5592Hit '?':
5593 [q, b, e, ?] ........
5594 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0xef6, ter=0x0
5595Hit '?':
5596 [q, b, e, ?] .
5597 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x2ad4, ter=0x0
5598Hit '?':
5599 [q, b, e, ?] .
5600 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x1efc, ter=0x0
5601Hit '?':
5602 [q, b, e, ?] .
5603 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x169d, ter=0x0
5604Hit 'e':
5605 [q, b, e, ?] ...Stopping timer
5606Hit 'q':
5607 [q, b, e, ?] ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005608
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005609
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005610Minicom warning:
5611================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005612
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005613Over time, many people have reported problems when trying to use the
5614"minicom" terminal emulation program for serial download. I (wd)
5615consider minicom to be broken, and recommend not to use it. Under
5616Unix, I recommend to use C-Kermit for general purpose use (and
5617especially for kermit binary protocol download ("loadb" command), and
Karl O. Pinca0189bb2012-10-01 05:11:56 +00005618use "cu" for S-Record download ("loads" command). See
5619http://www.denx.de/wiki/view/DULG/SystemSetup#Section_4.3.
5620for help with kermit.
5621
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005622
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005623Nevertheless, if you absolutely want to use it try adding this
5624configuration to your "File transfer protocols" section:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005625
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005626 Name Program Name U/D FullScr IO-Red. Multi
5627 X kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -s Y U Y N N
5628 Y kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -r N D Y N N
wdenk8dba0502003-03-31 16:34:49 +00005629
wdenk8dba0502003-03-31 16:34:49 +00005630
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005631NetBSD Notes:
5632=============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005633
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005634Starting at version 0.9.2, U-Boot supports NetBSD both as host
5635(build U-Boot) and target system (boots NetBSD/mpc8xx).
wdenk88e72a32003-06-19 23:04:19 +00005636
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005637Building requires a cross environment; it is known to work on
5638NetBSD/i386 with the cross-powerpc-netbsd-1.3 package (you will also
5639need gmake since the Makefiles are not compatible with BSD make).
5640Note that the cross-powerpc package does not install include files;
5641attempting to build U-Boot will fail because <machine/ansi.h> is
5642missing. This file has to be installed and patched manually:
wdenk88e72a32003-06-19 23:04:19 +00005643
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005644 # cd /usr/pkg/cross/powerpc-netbsd/include
5645 # mkdir powerpc
5646 # ln -s powerpc machine
5647 # cp /usr/src/sys/arch/powerpc/include/ansi.h powerpc/ansi.h
5648 # ${EDIT} powerpc/ansi.h ## must remove __va_list, _BSD_VA_LIST
wdenk88e72a32003-06-19 23:04:19 +00005649
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005650Native builds *don't* work due to incompatibilities between native
5651and U-Boot include files.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005652
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005653Booting assumes that (the first part of) the image booted is a
5654stage-2 loader which in turn loads and then invokes the kernel
5655proper. Loader sources will eventually appear in the NetBSD source
5656tree (probably in sys/arc/mpc8xx/stand/u-boot_stage2/); in the
wdenkd0245fc2005-04-13 10:02:42 +00005657meantime, see ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/ppcboot_stage2.tar.gz
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005658
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005659
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005660Implementation Internals:
5661=========================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005662
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005663The following is not intended to be a complete description of every
5664implementation detail. However, it should help to understand the
5665inner workings of U-Boot and make it easier to port it to custom
5666hardware.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005667
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005668
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005669Initial Stack, Global Data:
5670---------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005671
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005672The implementation of U-Boot is complicated by the fact that U-Boot
5673starts running out of ROM (flash memory), usually without access to
5674system RAM (because the memory controller is not initialized yet).
5675This means that we don't have writable Data or BSS segments, and BSS
5676is not initialized as zero. To be able to get a C environment working
5677at all, we have to allocate at least a minimal stack. Implementation
5678options for this are defined and restricted by the CPU used: Some CPU
5679models provide on-chip memory (like the IMMR area on MPC8xx and
5680MPC826x processors), on others (parts of) the data cache can be
5681locked as (mis-) used as memory, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005682
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005683 Chris Hallinan posted a good summary of these issues to the
Wolfgang Denk290ae6b2008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005684 U-Boot mailing list:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005685
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005686 Subject: RE: [U-Boot-Users] RE: More On Memory Bank x (nothingness)?
5687 From: "Chris Hallinan" <clh@net1plus.com>
5688 Date: Mon, 10 Feb 2003 16:43:46 -0500 (22:43 MET)
5689 ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005690
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005691 Correct me if I'm wrong, folks, but the way I understand it
5692 is this: Using DCACHE as initial RAM for Stack, etc, does not
5693 require any physical RAM backing up the cache. The cleverness
5694 is that the cache is being used as a temporary supply of
5695 necessary storage before the SDRAM controller is setup. It's
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005696 beyond the scope of this list to explain the details, but you
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005697 can see how this works by studying the cache architecture and
5698 operation in the architecture and processor-specific manuals.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005699
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005700 OCM is On Chip Memory, which I believe the 405GP has 4K. It
5701 is another option for the system designer to use as an
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005702 initial stack/RAM area prior to SDRAM being available. Either
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005703 option should work for you. Using CS 4 should be fine if your
5704 board designers haven't used it for something that would
5705 cause you grief during the initial boot! It is frequently not
5706 used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005707
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02005708 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR should be somewhere that won't interfere
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005709 with your processor/board/system design. The default value
5710 you will find in any recent u-boot distribution in
Stefan Roese3e1f1b32005-08-01 16:49:12 +02005711 walnut.h should work for you. I'd set it to a value larger
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005712 than your SDRAM module. If you have a 64MB SDRAM module, set
5713 it above 400_0000. Just make sure your board has no resources
5714 that are supposed to respond to that address! That code in
5715 start.S has been around a while and should work as is when
5716 you get the config right.
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005717
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005718 -Chris Hallinan
5719 DS4.COM, Inc.
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005720
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005721It is essential to remember this, since it has some impact on the C
5722code for the initialization procedures:
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005723
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005724* Initialized global data (data segment) is read-only. Do not attempt
5725 to write it.
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005726
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005727* Do not use any uninitialized global data (or implicitely initialized
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005728 as zero data - BSS segment) at all - this is undefined, initiali-
5729 zation is performed later (when relocating to RAM).
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005730
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005731* Stack space is very limited. Avoid big data buffers or things like
5732 that.
wdenk4a5c8a72003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005733
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005734Having only the stack as writable memory limits means we cannot use
5735normal global data to share information beween the code. But it
5736turned out that the implementation of U-Boot can be greatly
5737simplified by making a global data structure (gd_t) available to all
5738functions. We could pass a pointer to this data as argument to _all_
5739functions, but this would bloat the code. Instead we use a feature of
5740the GCC compiler (Global Register Variables) to share the data: we
5741place a pointer (gd) to the global data into a register which we
5742reserve for this purpose.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005743
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005744When choosing a register for such a purpose we are restricted by the
5745relevant (E)ABI specifications for the current architecture, and by
5746GCC's implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005747
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005748For PowerPC, the following registers have specific use:
5749 R1: stack pointer
Wolfgang Denk69c09642008-02-14 22:43:22 +01005750 R2: reserved for system use
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005751 R3-R4: parameter passing and return values
5752 R5-R10: parameter passing
5753 R13: small data area pointer
5754 R30: GOT pointer
5755 R31: frame pointer
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005756
Joakim Tjernlund693c0c12010-01-19 14:41:58 +01005757 (U-Boot also uses R12 as internal GOT pointer. r12
5758 is a volatile register so r12 needs to be reset when
5759 going back and forth between asm and C)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005760
Wolfgang Denk69c09642008-02-14 22:43:22 +01005761 ==> U-Boot will use R2 to hold a pointer to the global data
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005762
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005763 Note: on PPC, we could use a static initializer (since the
5764 address of the global data structure is known at compile time),
5765 but it turned out that reserving a register results in somewhat
5766 smaller code - although the code savings are not that big (on
5767 average for all boards 752 bytes for the whole U-Boot image,
5768 624 text + 127 data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005769
Robin Getz2773d5f2009-08-17 15:23:02 +00005770On Blackfin, the normal C ABI (except for P3) is followed as documented here:
Mike Frysinger60f09302008-02-04 19:26:54 -05005771 http://docs.blackfin.uclinux.org/doku.php?id=application_binary_interface
5772
Robin Getz2773d5f2009-08-17 15:23:02 +00005773 ==> U-Boot will use P3 to hold a pointer to the global data
Mike Frysinger60f09302008-02-04 19:26:54 -05005774
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005775On ARM, the following registers are used:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005776
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005777 R0: function argument word/integer result
5778 R1-R3: function argument word
Jeroen Hofsteea556aca2013-09-21 14:04:42 +02005779 R9: platform specific
5780 R10: stack limit (used only if stack checking is enabled)
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005781 R11: argument (frame) pointer
5782 R12: temporary workspace
5783 R13: stack pointer
5784 R14: link register
5785 R15: program counter
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005786
Jeroen Hofsteea556aca2013-09-21 14:04:42 +02005787 ==> U-Boot will use R9 to hold a pointer to the global data
5788
5789 Note: on ARM, only R_ARM_RELATIVE relocations are supported.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005790
Thomas Chou8fa38582010-05-21 11:08:03 +08005791On Nios II, the ABI is documented here:
5792 http://www.altera.com/literature/hb/nios2/n2cpu_nii51016.pdf
5793
5794 ==> U-Boot will use gp to hold a pointer to the global data
5795
5796 Note: on Nios II, we give "-G0" option to gcc and don't use gp
5797 to access small data sections, so gp is free.
5798
Macpaul Lin1cac36e2011-10-19 20:41:11 +00005799On NDS32, the following registers are used:
5800
5801 R0-R1: argument/return
5802 R2-R5: argument
5803 R15: temporary register for assembler
5804 R16: trampoline register
5805 R28: frame pointer (FP)
5806 R29: global pointer (GP)
5807 R30: link register (LP)
5808 R31: stack pointer (SP)
5809 PC: program counter (PC)
5810
5811 ==> U-Boot will use R10 to hold a pointer to the global data
5812
Wolfgang Denk6405a152006-03-31 18:32:53 +02005813NOTE: DECLARE_GLOBAL_DATA_PTR must be used with file-global scope,
5814or current versions of GCC may "optimize" the code too much.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005815
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005816Memory Management:
5817------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005818
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005819U-Boot runs in system state and uses physical addresses, i.e. the
5820MMU is not used either for address mapping nor for memory protection.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005821
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005822The available memory is mapped to fixed addresses using the memory
5823controller. In this process, a contiguous block is formed for each
5824memory type (Flash, SDRAM, SRAM), even when it consists of several
5825physical memory banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005826
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005827U-Boot is installed in the first 128 kB of the first Flash bank (on
5828TQM8xxL modules this is the range 0x40000000 ... 0x4001FFFF). After
5829booting and sizing and initializing DRAM, the code relocates itself
5830to the upper end of DRAM. Immediately below the U-Boot code some
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD03836942008-10-16 15:01:15 +02005831memory is reserved for use by malloc() [see CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005832configuration setting]. Below that, a structure with global Board
5833Info data is placed, followed by the stack (growing downward).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005834
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005835Additionally, some exception handler code is copied to the low 8 kB
5836of DRAM (0x00000000 ... 0x00001FFF).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005837
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005838So a typical memory configuration with 16 MB of DRAM could look like
5839this:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005840
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005841 0x0000 0000 Exception Vector code
5842 :
5843 0x0000 1FFF
5844 0x0000 2000 Free for Application Use
5845 :
5846 :
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005847
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005848 :
5849 :
5850 0x00FB FF20 Monitor Stack (Growing downward)
5851 0x00FB FFAC Board Info Data and permanent copy of global data
5852 0x00FC 0000 Malloc Arena
5853 :
5854 0x00FD FFFF
5855 0x00FE 0000 RAM Copy of Monitor Code
5856 ... eventually: LCD or video framebuffer
5857 ... eventually: pRAM (Protected RAM - unchanged by reset)
5858 0x00FF FFFF [End of RAM]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005859
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005860
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005861System Initialization:
5862----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005863
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005864In the reset configuration, U-Boot starts at the reset entry point
Marcel Ziswilerabd8dcb2008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005865(on most PowerPC systems at address 0x00000100). Because of the reset
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005866configuration for CS0# this is a mirror of the onboard Flash memory.
5867To be able to re-map memory U-Boot then jumps to its link address.
5868To be able to implement the initialization code in C, a (small!)
5869initial stack is set up in the internal Dual Ported RAM (in case CPUs
5870which provide such a feature like MPC8xx or MPC8260), or in a locked
5871part of the data cache. After that, U-Boot initializes the CPU core,
5872the caches and the SIU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005873
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005874Next, all (potentially) available memory banks are mapped using a
5875preliminary mapping. For example, we put them on 512 MB boundaries
5876(multiples of 0x20000000: SDRAM on 0x00000000 and 0x20000000, Flash
5877on 0x40000000 and 0x60000000, SRAM on 0x80000000). Then UPM A is
5878programmed for SDRAM access. Using the temporary configuration, a
5879simple memory test is run that determines the size of the SDRAM
5880banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005881
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005882When there is more than one SDRAM bank, and the banks are of
5883different size, the largest is mapped first. For equal size, the first
5884bank (CS2#) is mapped first. The first mapping is always for address
58850x00000000, with any additional banks following immediately to create
5886contiguous memory starting from 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005887
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005888Then, the monitor installs itself at the upper end of the SDRAM area
5889and allocates memory for use by malloc() and for the global Board
5890Info data; also, the exception vector code is copied to the low RAM
5891pages, and the final stack is set up.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005892
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005893Only after this relocation will you have a "normal" C environment;
5894until that you are restricted in several ways, mostly because you are
5895running from ROM, and because the code will have to be relocated to a
5896new address in RAM.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005897
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005898
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005899U-Boot Porting Guide:
5900----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005901
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005902[Based on messages by Jerry Van Baren in the U-Boot-Users mailing
5903list, October 2002]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005904
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005905
Jerry Van Barenba0687c2009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005906int main(int argc, char *argv[])
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005907{
5908 sighandler_t no_more_time;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005909
Jerry Van Barenba0687c2009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005910 signal(SIGALRM, no_more_time);
5911 alarm(PROJECT_DEADLINE - toSec (3 * WEEK));
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005912
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005913 if (available_money > available_manpower) {
Jerry Van Barenba0687c2009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005914 Pay consultant to port U-Boot;
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005915 return 0;
5916 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005917
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005918 Download latest U-Boot source;
wdenk34b613e2002-12-17 01:51:00 +00005919
Wolfgang Denk290ae6b2008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005920 Subscribe to u-boot mailing list;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005921
Jerry Van Barenba0687c2009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005922 if (clueless)
5923 email("Hi, I am new to U-Boot, how do I get started?");
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005924
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005925 while (learning) {
5926 Read the README file in the top level directory;
Jerry Van Barenba0687c2009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005927 Read http://www.denx.de/twiki/bin/view/DULG/Manual;
5928 Read applicable doc/*.README;
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005929 Read the source, Luke;
Jerry Van Barenba0687c2009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005930 /* find . -name "*.[chS]" | xargs grep -i <keyword> */
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005931 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005932
Jerry Van Barenba0687c2009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005933 if (available_money > toLocalCurrency ($2500))
5934 Buy a BDI3000;
5935 else
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005936 Add a lot of aggravation and time;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005937
Jerry Van Barenba0687c2009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005938 if (a similar board exists) { /* hopefully... */
5939 cp -a board/<similar> board/<myboard>
5940 cp include/configs/<similar>.h include/configs/<myboard>.h
5941 } else {
5942 Create your own board support subdirectory;
5943 Create your own board include/configs/<myboard>.h file;
5944 }
5945 Edit new board/<myboard> files
5946 Edit new include/configs/<myboard>.h
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005947
Jerry Van Barenba0687c2009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005948 while (!accepted) {
5949 while (!running) {
5950 do {
5951 Add / modify source code;
5952 } until (compiles);
5953 Debug;
5954 if (clueless)
5955 email("Hi, I am having problems...");
5956 }
5957 Send patch file to the U-Boot email list;
5958 if (reasonable critiques)
5959 Incorporate improvements from email list code review;
5960 else
5961 Defend code as written;
wdenk634d2f72004-04-15 23:14:49 +00005962 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005963
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005964 return 0;
5965}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005966
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005967void no_more_time (int sig)
5968{
5969 hire_a_guru();
5970}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005971
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005972
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005973Coding Standards:
5974-----------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005975
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005976All contributions to U-Boot should conform to the Linux kernel
Detlev Zundelaa63d482006-09-01 15:39:02 +02005977coding style; see the file "Documentation/CodingStyle" and the script
Wolfgang Denk20bd2a62011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005978"scripts/Lindent" in your Linux kernel source directory.
Detlev Zundelaa63d482006-09-01 15:39:02 +02005979
5980Source files originating from a different project (for example the
5981MTD subsystem) are generally exempt from these guidelines and are not
5982reformated to ease subsequent migration to newer versions of those
5983sources.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005984
Detlev Zundelaa63d482006-09-01 15:39:02 +02005985Please note that U-Boot is implemented in C (and to some small parts in
5986Assembler); no C++ is used, so please do not use C++ style comments (//)
5987in your code.
wdenkad276f22004-01-04 16:28:35 +00005988
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005989Please also stick to the following formatting rules:
5990- remove any trailing white space
Wolfgang Denk20bd2a62011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005991- use TAB characters for indentation and vertical alignment, not spaces
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005992- make sure NOT to use DOS '\r\n' line feeds
Wolfgang Denk20bd2a62011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005993- do not add more than 2 consecutive empty lines to source files
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005994- do not add trailing empty lines to source files
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005995
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005996Submissions which do not conform to the standards may be returned
5997with a request to reformat the changes.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005998
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005999
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006000Submitting Patches:
6001-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006002
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006003Since the number of patches for U-Boot is growing, we need to
6004establish some rules. Submissions which do not conform to these rules
6005may be rejected, even when they contain important and valuable stuff.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006006
Magnus Liljaf3b287b2008-08-06 19:32:33 +02006007Please see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/Patches for details.
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006008
Wolfgang Denk290ae6b2008-12-30 22:56:11 +01006009Patches shall be sent to the u-boot mailing list <u-boot@lists.denx.de>;
6010see http://lists.denx.de/mailman/listinfo/u-boot
6011
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006012When you send a patch, please include the following information with
6013it:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006014
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006015* For bug fixes: a description of the bug and how your patch fixes
6016 this bug. Please try to include a way of demonstrating that the
6017 patch actually fixes something.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006018
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006019* For new features: a description of the feature and your
6020 implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006021
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006022* A CHANGELOG entry as plaintext (separate from the patch)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006023
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006024* For major contributions, your entry to the CREDITS file
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006025
Albert ARIBAUD48e910f2013-09-11 15:52:51 +02006026* When you add support for a new board, don't forget to add a
6027 maintainer e-mail address to the boards.cfg file, too.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006028
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006029* If your patch adds new configuration options, don't forget to
6030 document these in the README file.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006031
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006032* The patch itself. If you are using git (which is *strongly*
6033 recommended) you can easily generate the patch using the
Wolfgang Denk20bd2a62011-07-27 10:59:55 +00006034 "git format-patch". If you then use "git send-email" to send it to
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006035 the U-Boot mailing list, you will avoid most of the common problems
6036 with some other mail clients.
wdenkca9bc762003-07-15 07:45:49 +00006037
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006038 If you cannot use git, use "diff -purN OLD NEW". If your version of
6039 diff does not support these options, then get the latest version of
6040 GNU diff.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006041
Wolfgang Denkb240aef2008-03-26 10:40:12 +01006042 The current directory when running this command shall be the parent
6043 directory of the U-Boot source tree (i. e. please make sure that
6044 your patch includes sufficient directory information for the
6045 affected files).
6046
6047 We prefer patches as plain text. MIME attachments are discouraged,
6048 and compressed attachments must not be used.
wdenk88e72a32003-06-19 23:04:19 +00006049
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006050* If one logical set of modifications affects or creates several
6051 files, all these changes shall be submitted in a SINGLE patch file.
wdenk57b2d802003-06-27 21:31:46 +00006052
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006053* Changesets that contain different, unrelated modifications shall be
6054 submitted as SEPARATE patches, one patch per changeset.
wdenk88e72a32003-06-19 23:04:19 +00006055
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006056
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006057Notes:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006058
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006059* Before sending the patch, run the MAKEALL script on your patched
6060 source tree and make sure that no errors or warnings are reported
6061 for any of the boards.
6062
6063* Keep your modifications to the necessary minimum: A patch
6064 containing several unrelated changes or arbitrary reformats will be
6065 returned with a request to re-formatting / split it.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00006066
wdenk6c59edc2004-05-03 20:45:30 +00006067* If you modify existing code, make sure that your new code does not
6068 add to the memory footprint of the code ;-) Small is beautiful!
6069 When adding new features, these should compile conditionally only
6070 (using #ifdef), and the resulting code with the new feature
6071 disabled must not need more memory than the old code without your
6072 modification.
wdenkcbc49a52005-05-03 14:12:25 +00006073
Wolfgang Denk290ae6b2008-12-30 22:56:11 +01006074* Remember that there is a size limit of 100 kB per message on the
6075 u-boot mailing list. Bigger patches will be moderated. If they are
6076 reasonable and not too big, they will be acknowledged. But patches
6077 bigger than the size limit should be avoided.